2011 Buick Lucerne Owner Manual M
In Brief . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Instrument Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Initial Drive Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Vehicle Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Performance and Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Seats and Restraint System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Airbag System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Restraint System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Features and Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Doors and Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Starting and Operating Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Object Detection Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Universal Home Remote System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Storage Areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2011 Buick Lucerne Owner Manual M
The names, logos, emblems, slogans, vehicle model names, and vehicle body designs appearing in this manual including, but not limited to, GM, the GM logo, BUICK, the BUICK Emblem, and LUCERNE are trademarks and/or service marks of General Motors LLC, its subsidiaries, affiliates, or licensors.
This manual describes features that may or may not be on your specific vehicle either because they are options that you did not purchase or due to changes subsequent to the printing of this owner manual. Please refer to the purchase documentation relating to your specific vehicle to confirm each of the features found on your vehicle. For vehicles first sold in Canada, substitute the name ???General Motors of Canada Limited??? for Buick Motor Division wherever it appears in this manual.
Keep this manual in the vehicle for quick reference.
Canadian Owners
Propri??taires Canadiens
A French language copy of this manual can be obtained from your dealer or from:
On peut obtenir un exemplaire de ce guide en fran??ais aupr??s du concessionnaire ou ?? l'adresse suivante:
Helm, Incorporated
P.O. Box 07130
Detroit, MI 48207
Num??ro de poste 6438 de langue fran??aise
www.helminc.com
Index
To quickly locate information about the vehicle, use the index in the back of the manual. It is an alphabetical list of what is in the manual and the page number where it can be found.
Safety Warnings and Symbols
Warning messages found on vehicle labels and in this manual describe hazards and what to do to avoid or reduce them.
Danger indicates a hazard with a high level of risk which will result in serious injury or death.
Warning or Caution indicates a hazard that could result in injury or death.
{ WARNING:
These mean there is something that could hurt you or other people.
Notice: This means there is something that could result in property or vehicle damage. This would not be covered by the vehicle's warranty.
A circle with a slash through it is a safety symbol which means ???Do Not,??? ???Do not do this,??? or ???Do not let this happen.???
Vehicle Symbols
The vehicle has components and labels that use symbols instead of text. Symbols are shown along with the text describing the operation or information relating to a specific component, control, message, gauge,
or indicator.
M : This symbol is shown when you need to see your owner manual for additional instructions or information.
* : This symbol is shown when you need to see a service manual for additional instructions or information.
iv
Vehicle Symbol Chart
Here are some additional symbols that may be found on the vehicle and what they mean. For more information on the symbol, refer to the Index.
9 : Airbag Readiness Light
# : Air Conditioning
! : Antilock Brake System (ABS)
g : Audio Steering Wheel Controls or OnStar??
$ : Brake System Warning Light
" : Charging System
I : Cruise Control
B : Engine Coolant Temperature
O : Exterior Lamps
# : Fog Lamps
. : Fuel Gauge
+ : Fuses
3 : Headlamp
j : LATCH System Child Restraints
* : Malfunction Indicator Lamp
: : Oil Pressure
} : Power
/ : Remote Vehicle Start
> : Safety Belt Reminders
7 : Tire Pressure Monitor
F : Traction Control
M : Windshield Washer Fluid
v
2 NOTES
vi
Section 1 In Brief
Instrument Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Initial Drive Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Vehicle Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
USB Port) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Steering Wheel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Navigation System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Performance and Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Traction Control System (TCS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tire Pressure Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Roadside Assistance Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Instrument Panel
A.Outlet Adjustment on page 4???24.
B.DIC Operation and Displays on page 4???41
(If Equipped).
C.Turn Signal/Multifunction Lever on page 4???4.
Windshield Wipers on page 4???6.
D.Instrument Panel Cluster on page 4???27.
E.Hazard Warning Flashers on page 4???3.
F. Audio System(s) on page 4???64.
G.Exterior Lamps on page 4???10.
H.Trunk Release. See Trunk on page 3???11.
I.Instrument Panel Brightness on page 4???12.
J.Hood Release on page 6???13.
K.Lane Departure Warning (LDW) on page 3???38
(If Equipped).
L.Cruise Control on page 4??? 7.
Heated Steering Wheel on page 4??? 4
(If Equipped).
M.Data Link Connector (DLC). See Malfunction Indicator Lamp on page 4???36.
N.Parking Brake on page 3???24.
O.Audio Steering Wheel Controls on page 4???90
(If Equipped).
P.Climate Control System on page 4???16
(If Equipped).
Dual Automatic Climate Control System on page 4???19.
Q.Traction Control System (TCS) on page 5???6.
StabiliTrak?? System on page 5???6.
R.Front Storage Area on page 3???47.
S.Shift Lever. See Automatic Transmission Operation on page 3???22.
T.Accessory Power Outlet(s) on page 4???15.
U.Glove Box on page 3???47.
Initial Drive Information
This section provides a brief overview about some of the important features that may or may not be on your specific vehicle.
For more detailed information, refer to each of the features which can be found later in this owner manual.
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System
The RKE transmitter is used to remotely lock and unlock the doors from up to 60 m (195 feet) away from the vehicle.
Press K to unlock the driver door. Press again within five seconds to unlock all remaining doors.
Press Q to lock all doors.
Lock and unlock feedback can be personalized.
Press and hold V for approximately one second to open the trunk.
Press L and release to locate the vehicle.
Press L and hold for more than two seconds to sound the panic alarm.
Press L again to cancel the panic alarm.
See Keys on page 3??? 3 and Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation on page 3???4.
Remote Vehicle Start
With this feature the engine can be started from outside of the vehicle.
Starting the Vehicle
1.Aim the RKE transmitter at the vehicle.
2.Press Q.
3.Immediately after completing Step 2, press and hold / until the turn signal lamps flash.
When the vehicle starts, the parking lamps will turn on and remain on as long as the engine is running. The doors will be locked and the climate control system may come on.
The engine will continue to run for 10 minutes. Repeat the steps for a
Canceling a Remote Start
To cancel a remote start:
.Aim the RKE transmitter at the vehicle and press and hold / until the parking lamps turn off.
. Turn on the hazard warning flashers.
. Turn the ignition on and then back off.
See Remote Vehicle Start on page 3???6.
Door Locks
From the outside, unlock the door using either the key or the RKE transmitter.
From the inside, use the power door lock switches or manual lock knobs located at the top of the door panel near the window.
Power Door Locks
On vehicles with power door locks, the switches are located on the front doors.
" (Unlock): Press to unlock the doors.
Q (Lock): Remove the key from the ignition and press to lock the doors.
For more information, see:
. Door Locks on page 3???8.
. Power Door Locks on page 3???9.
.Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation on page 3??? 4.
Trunk Release
In addition to the trunk release button on the RKE transmitter, there is a remote release V button located to the left of the steering wheel, next to the instrument panel brightness control. Press to open the trunk.
See Trunk on page 3???11.
On vehicles with power windows, the switches are on the driver door armrest. Each passenger door has a switch that controls only that window.
Press the switch to lower the window. Pull the switch up to raise it.
For more information, see Power Windows on page 3???14.
Use the horizontal control on the outboard side of the seat to adjust the seat.
.Move the seat forward or rearward by sliding the control forward or rearward.
.Raise or lower the seat by moving the control up or down.
See Power Seats on page 2???3.
Use the vertical control on the outboard side of the seat to adjust the seatback.
To raise or recline the seatback, tilt the top of the control forward or rearward.
See Reclining Seatbacks on page 2???9.
Use the round control on the outboard side of the seat to adjust the lumbar support.
See Power Lumbar on page 2??? 4 for information on operation.
Memory Features
On vehicles with the memory feature, the controls on the driver door are used to program and recall memory settings for the driver seat, outside mirrors, and the power steering column, if the vehicle has this feature.
1:Saves and recalls for driver 1.
2:Saves and recalls for driver 2.
S : Recalls the easy exit driver seat and power steering column positions.
Storing Memory Positions
To save into memory:
1.Adjust the driver seat, seatback recliner, lumbar, both outside mirrors, and the power steering column, if equipped.
2.Press and hold ???1??? until two beeps sound.
3.Repeat for a second driver position using ???2.???
To recall the memory positions, press and release ???1??? or ???2.??? The vehicle must be in P (Park). A single beep will sound. The seat, outside mirrors, and power steering column, if equipped, will move to the positions previously stored for the identified driver.
See Memory Seat and Mirrors on page 2??? 7 for more information.
Easy Exit Positions
The easy exit feature can move the driver seat rearward and the power steering column, if equipped, up and forward to allow extra room to exit the vehicle.
S : Press to recall the easy exit positions. The vehicle must be in P (Park).
See Memory Seat and Mirrors on page 2??? 7 and ???Easy Exit Recall??? and ???Easy Exit Setup??? under DIC Vehicle Customization on page 4???56 for more information.
On vehicles with heated seats, the buttons are on the front doors. The ignition must be on to use this feature.
J : Press to heat the seat and seatback.
I : Press to heat the seatback.
For more information see Heated Seats on page 2???5.
On vehicles with heated and ventilated seats, the buttons are on the front doors. The ignition must be on to use this feature.
J : Press to heat the seat and seatback.
I : Press to heat the seatback.
H : Press to cool the seat and seatback.
For more information see Heated and Ventilated Seats on page 2??? 6.
Head Restraint Adjustment
The vehicle's front seats have adjustable head restraints in the outboard seating positions.
Do not drive until the head restraints for all occupants are installed and adjusted properly.
To achieve a comfortable seating position, change the seatback recline angle as little as necessary while keeping the seat and the head restraint height in the proper position.
For more information see Head Restraints on page 2??? 2 and Power Seats on page 2???3.
Safety Belt
Refer to the following sections for important information on how to use safety belts properly.
. Safety Belts: They Are for Everyone on page 2???12.
. How to Wear Safety Belts Properly on page 2???16.
.
. Lap Belt on page 2???30.
.Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH) on page 2???43.
Sensing System for Passenger Airbag
The passenger sensing system will turn off the right front passenger frontal airbag and seat???mounted side impact airbag under certain conditions. The driver airbags and roof???rail airbags are not affected by this.
The passenger airbag status indicator will be visible on the overhead console when the vehicle is started.
See Passenger Sensing System on page 2???65 for important information.
Mirror Adjustment
Exterior Mirrors
Controls for the outside power mirrors are located on the driver door armrest.
1.Press the left or right side of the selector switch located beneath the control pad to choose the driver or passenger side mirror.
2.Press one of the four arrows located on the control pad to move the mirror in the desired direction.
Manually fold the mirrors inward to prevent damage when going through an automatic car wash. To fold, push the mirror toward the vehicle. Push the mirror outward, to return to its original position.
Interior Mirror
The vehicle has an automatic dimming inside rearview mirror. Automatic dimming reduces the glare of lights from behind the vehicle. The dimming feature comes on and the indicator light illuminates each time the vehicle is started.
Press the Obutton, located on the mirror, to turn the dimming feature and compass on or off.
See Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror on page 3???29.
Steering Wheel Adjustment
The lever is located on the left side of the steering column.
To adjust the steering wheel:
1.Hold the wheel and pull the lever toward you.
2.Move the steering wheel up or down.
3.Release the lever to lock the wheel in place.
Power Tilt Wheel and Telescopic Steering
Column
For vehicles with a power tilt control, it is located on the left hand side of the steering column.
To adjust the steering wheel, push the control up, down, forward or backward.
Do not adjust the steering wheel while driving.
See Tilt Wheel on page 4??? 3 or Power Tilt Wheel and Telescopic Steering Column on page 4??? 4 (If Equipped).
Interior Lighting
Courtesy Lamps
When any door is opened, the interior lamps turn on to enter and exit the vehicle. Turn the instrument panel
brightness control D located on the left side of the steering wheel, completely clockwise to manually turn on these lamps.
Front Reading Lamps
The front reading lamps are located on the headliner. Press the button near each lamp to turn them on or off.
For more information on interior lighting, see:
. Courtesy Lamps on page 4???12.
. Instrument Panel Brightness on page 4???12.
. Delayed Entry Lighting on page 4???13.
. Delayed Exit Lighting on page 4???13.
Exterior Lighting
The exterior lamp control is located on the instrument panel to the left of the steering wheel.
P: Turns off the exterior lamps.
AUTO: Automatic operation of the headlamps and other exterior lamps.
;: Manual operation of the parking lamps and other exterior lamps.
2: Manual operation of the headlamps and other exterior lamps.
#: Press to turn on the fog lamps.
For more information, see:
. Exterior Lamps on page 4???10.
. Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) on page 4???11.
. Fog Lamps on page 4???12.
. Wiper Activated Headlamps on page 4???11.
Windshield Wiper/Washer
The windshield wiper lever is located on the left side of the steering column.
8: Use for a single wiping cycle.
6 : Delays wiping cycle.
6: Slow wipes.
1: Fast wipes.
9: Turns the wipers off.
J: Press and release this paddle, located at the top of the turn signal/multifunction lever, to spray washer fluid on the windshield.
See Windshield Wipers on page 4??? 6 and Windshield Washer on page 4???7.
Climate Controls
See Climate Control System on page 4???16
(If Equipped).
This system allows the driver and passenger to control the temperature settings separately.
Vehicle Features
Radio(s)
See Dual Automatic Climate Control System on page 4???19 (If Equipped).
Radio with CD (MP3)
O: Press to turn the system on and off. Turn to increase or decrease the volume.
BAND: Press to choose between FM, AM, or XM???, if equipped.
f : Select radio stations.
?? ?? : Seek or scan stations.
4 (XM??? Satellite Radio Service, MP3, and RDS Features) : Press this button to display additional text information related to the current
For more information about these and other radio features, see Audio System(s) on page 4???64.
Storing a Favorite Station
For vehicles with an XM radio, a maximum of 36 stations can be stored as favorites using the
six softkeys located below the radio station frequency tabs and by using the radio FAV button. Press FAV to go through up to six pages of favorites, each having six favorite stations available per page. Each page of favorites can contain any combination of AM, FM, or XM stations.
See Radio(s) on page 4???66.
Setting the Clock
To set the time and date for the radio with CD (MP3):
1.Turn the ignition key to ACC/ACCESSORY or ON/RUN.
2.Press Oto turn the radio on.
3.Press H and the HR, MIN, MM, DD, YYYY (hour, minute, month, day, and year) displays.
4.Press the softkey located below any one of the tabs that you want to change.
5.Increase or decrease the time or date by turning f clockwise or counterclockwise.
For detailed instructions on setting the clock for your specific audio system, see Setting the Clock on page 4???65.
Satellite Radio
XM is a satellite radio service that is based in the 48 contiguous United States and 10 Canadian provinces. XM satellite radio has a wide variety of programming and
A fee is required to receive the XM service.
For more information, refer to:
.www.xmradio.com or call
.www.xmradio.ca or call
See ???XM Satellite Radio Service??? under Radio(s) on page 4???66.
Portable Audio Devices (Auxiliary Input or USB Port)
This vehicle may have an auxiliary input jack and a USB port, located on the audio faceplate. External devices such as iPods??, laptop computers, MP3 players, CD changers, USB storage devices, etc. can be connected to the auxiliary input jack using a 3.5 mm (1/8 in) cable or the USB port depending on the audio system.
Press the CD/AUX button to play audio from the portable player.
See ???Using the Auxiliary Input Jack??? and ???Using the USB Port??? under Radio(s) on page 4???66.
Steering Wheel Controls
For vehicles with audio steering wheel controls, some audio controls can be adjusted at the steering wheel.
w / x : Press to change favorite radio stations, select tracks on a CD/DVD, or to navigate tracks or folders on an iPod?? or USB device.
b g : Press to silence the vehicle speakers only. Press again to turn the sound on. Press and hold longer than two seconds to interact with OnStar?? or Bluetooth systems, if equipped.
+ e ??? e : Increases or decreases volume.
c : Press to reject an incoming call, or to end a call.
SRCE: Press to switch between the radio, CD, and for vehicles with, DVD, front auxiliary, and rear auxiliary.
?? : Press to seek the next radio station, the next track or chapter while sourced to the CD or DVD slot, or to select tracks and folders on an iPod?? or USB device.
For more information, see Audio Steering Wheel Controls on page 4???90.
Bluetooth??
For vehicles with an
The Bluetooth enabled cell phone must be paired with the
For more information, see Bluetooth?? on page 4???82.
Navigation System
The vehicle's navigation system provides detailed maps of most major freeways and roads throughout the United States and Canada. After a destination has been set, the system provides
See the vehicle's Navigation System manual for more information.
Driver Information Center (DIC)
The DIC display is located at the bottom of the instrument panel cluster. It shows the status of many vehicle systems and enables access to the personalization menu.
The DIC buttons are located on the instrument panel to the left of the instrument panel cluster.
3 : Press to scroll through the trip and fuel displays.
T: Press to scroll through the vehicle information displays.
U : Press to customize the feature settings on your vehicle. See DIC Vehicle Customization on page 4???56 for more information.
V : Press to reset certain DIC features and to acknowledge DIC warning messages and clear them from the display.
For more information, see Driver Information Center (DIC) on page 4???40.
Some vehicle features can be programmed by using the DIC buttons on the instrument panel to the left of the steering wheel. These features include:
.Language
.Door Lock and Unlock Settings
.Lighting
.Chime Volume
.Memory Settings
See DIC Vehicle Customization on page 4???56.
The cruise control buttons are located on the left side of the steering wheel.
T: Press to turn the cruise control on or off.
+ RES: Press briefly to make the vehicle resume to a previously set speed, or press and hold to accelerate.
[ (Cancel): Press to disengage cruise control without erasing the set speed from memory.
For more information, see Cruise Control on page 4???7.
Lane Departure Warning (LDW)
For vehicles with LDW, it is intended to help avoid lane change collisions. It provides a warning if the vehicle is crossing a lane without using a turn signal. LDW uses a camera to detect the lane markings. It only operates at speeds of 56 km (35 mph) or greater.
The warning symbol @, located in the instrument panel cluster, appears green if a lane marking is detected.
It changes to amber, flashes, and sounds three chimes if the vehicle crosses a detected land marking and the turn signal is not on.
To turn LDW on and off, press the LDW button, located by the exterior headlamp control.
See Lane Departure Warning (LDW) on page 3???38 for more information.
Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA)
For vehicles with this feature, it may alert you to vehicles located in your side blind zone. When the system detects a vehicle in the side blind zone, an SBZA display will light up in the corresponding outside side mirror indicating that it may not be safe to change lanes.
The system is enabled at every vehicle startup. It can be disabled through the Driver Information Center (DIC).
If the message SIDE BLIND ZONE SYS. UNAVAILABLE appears on the DIC, the system has been disabled because the sensor is blocked and cannot detect vehicles in the blind zone. The sensors, located behind the rear quarter panels, may be blocked by mud, dirt, snow, ice, slush, or even heavy rainstorms. The vehicle does not need service.
See Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) on page 3???34 for more information.
Ultrasonic Parking Assist
For vehicles with this feature, it uses sensors on the rear bumper to detect objects while parking the vehicle. It operates at speeds less than 8 km/h (5 mph) while in R (Reverse).
Keep the sensors on the vehicle's rear bumper clean to ensure proper operation.
The system can be disabled through the Driver Information Center (DIC).
See Ultrasonic Rear Parking Assist (URPA) on page 3???33 for more information.
Power Outlets
The accessory power outlets can be used to plug in electrical equipment, such as a cell phone or MP3 player.
The vehicle may have up to three power outlets depending on the type of front seat installed. If the vehicle has front bucket seats with a center console, there are two outlets inside the center console storage bin, one accessory power outlet and one USB port outlet. An extra power outlet can be found under the climate control system next to the ashtray.
See Accessory Power Outlet(s) on page 4???15.
Universal Remote System
The Universal Home Remote System allows for garage door openers, security systems, and home automation devices to be programmed to work with these buttons in the vehicle.
See Universal Home Remote System on page 3???40.
Performance and Maintenance
Traction Control System (TCS)
The traction control system limits wheel spin. The system turns on automatically every time the vehicle is started.
.To turn off traction control, press and release i in front of the shift lever. F illuminates and the appropriate DIC message is displayed. See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 4???47.
.Press and release the button again to turn on traction control.
For more information, see Traction Control System (TCS) on page 5???6.
StabiliTrak?? System
The vehicle has a StabiliTrak system that assists with directional control of the vehicle in difficult driving conditions. The system turns on automatically every time the vehicle is started. The system cannot be turned off.
For more information, see StabiliTrak?? System on
page 5??? 6.
Tire Pressure Monitor
This vehicle may have a Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS).
The TPMS warming light alerts you to a significant loss in pressure of one of the vehicles tires.
If the warning light comes on, stop as soon as possible and inflate the tires to the recommended pressure shown on the tire loading information label. See
Loading the Vehicle on page 5???18. The warning light will remain on until the tire pressure is corrected.
During cooler conditions, the low tire pressure warning light may appear when the vehicle is first started and then turn off. This may be an early indicator that the tire pressures are getting low and the tires need to be inflated to the proper pressure.
The TPMS does not replace normal monthly tire maintenance. It is the driver???s responsibility to maintain correct tire pressures.
See Tire Pressure Monitor System on page 6???64 and Tire Pressure Monitor Operation on page 6???65.
Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit
This vehicle may come with a jack and spare tire or a tire sealant and compressor kit. The kit can be used to seal small punctures in the tread area of the tire.
See Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit on page 6???79 for complete operating information.
If the vehicle came with a jack and spare tire, see
Changing a Flat Tire on page 6???87.
Engine Oil Life System
The engine oil life system calculates engine oil life based on vehicle use and displays a DIC message when it is necessary to change the engine oil and filter. The oil life system should be reset to 100% only following an oil change.
Resetting the Oil Life System
1.Display the OIL LIFE REMAINING on the DIC.
2.Press and hold the SET/RESET button on the DIC for more than five seconds. The oil life will change to 100%.
See Engine Oil Life System on page 6???22.
Fuel E85 (85% Ethanol)
Vehicles that have a FlexFuel badge and a yellow fuel cap can use either unleaded gasoline or ethanol fuel containing up to 85% ethanol (E85). See Fuel E85 (85% Ethanol) on page 6??? 8. For all other vehicles, use only the unleaded gasoline described under
Gasoline Octane on page 6???6.
Driving for Better Fuel Economy
Driving habits can affect fuel mileage. Here are some driving tips to get the best fuel economy possible.
.Avoid fast starts and accelerate smoothly.
.Brake gradually and avoid abrupt stops.
.Avoid idling the engine for long periods of time.
.When road and weather conditions are appropriate, use cruise control, if equipped.
.Always follow posted speed limits or drive more slowly when conditions require.
.Keep vehicle tires properly inflated.
.Combine several trips into a single trip.
.Replace the vehicle's tires with the same TPC Spec number molded into the tire's sidewall near the size.
.Follow recommended scheduled maintenance.
Roadside Assistance Program
U.S.:
TTY Users:
Canada:
As the owner of a new Buick, you are automatically enrolled in the Roadside Assistance program. This program provides technically trained advisors who are available 24 hours a day, 365 days a year, minor repair information or towing arrangements.
For more information see Roadside Assistance Program on page 8??? 7.
Roadside Assistance and OnStar
If you have a current OnStar subscription, press the Q button and the current GPS location will be sent to an OnStar Advisor who will assess your problem, contact Roadside Assistance, and relay exact location to get you the help you need.
Online Owner Center
The Online Owner Center is a complimentary service that includes online service reminders, vehicle maintenance tips, online owner manual, special privileges and more.
Sign up today at: www.buickownercenter.com (U.S.) or www.gm.ca (Canada).
OnStar??
OnStar?? uses several innovative technologies and live advisors to provide a wide range of safety, security, navigation, diagnostics, and calling services.
Automatic Crash Response
In a crash, built in sensors can automatically alert an OnStar advisor who is immediately connected to the vehicle to see if you need help.
How OnStar Service Works
Q: This blue button connects you to a specially trained OnStar advisor to verify your account information and to answer questions.
] : Push this red emergency button to get priority help from specially trained OnStar emergency advisors.
X : Push this button for hands???free, voice???activated calling and to give voice commands for turn???by???turn navigation.
Crisis Assist, Stolen Vehicle Assistance, Vehicle Diagnostics, Remote Door Unlock, Roadside Assistance, Turn???by???Turn Navigation and Hands???Free Calling are available on most vehicles. Not all OnStar services are available on all vehicles. For more information see the OnStar Owner's Guide or visit www.onstar.com (U.S.) or www.onstar.ca (Canada), contact OnStar at
or TTY 1???877???248???2080, or press Qto speak with an OnStar advisor 24 hours a day, 7 days a week.
For a full description of OnStar services and system limitations, see the OnStar Owner's Guide in the glove box.
OnStar service is subject to the OnStar terms and conditions included in the OnStar Subscriber Information.
OnStar service cannot work unless the vehicle is in a place where OnStar has an agreement with a wireless service provider for service in that area. OnStar service also cannot work unless the vehicle is in a place where the wireless service provider OnStar has hired for that area has coverage, network capacity and reception when the service is needed, and technology that is compatible with the OnStar service. Not all services are available everywhere, particularly in remote or enclosed areas, or at all times.
The OnStar system can record and transmit vehicle information. This information is automatically sent to an
OnStar call center when Qis pressed, ] is pressed, or if the airbags or ACR system deploy. This information usually includes the vehicle's GPS location and, in the event of a crash, additional information regarding the crash that the vehicle was involved in (e.g. the direction from which the vehicle was hit). When the virtual advisor feature of OnStar
Location information about the vehicle is only available if the GPS satellite signals are unobstructed and available.
The vehicle must have a working electrical system, including adequate battery power, for the OnStar equipment to operate. There are other problems OnStar cannot control that may prevent OnStar from providing OnStar service at any particular time or place. Some examples are damage to important parts of the vehicle in a crash, hills, tall buildings, tunnels, weather or wireless phone network congestion.
OnStar Steering Wheel Controls
This vehicle may have a Talk/Mute button that can be used to interact with OnStar
Audio Steering Wheel Controls on page 4???90 for more information.
On some vehicles, the mute button can be used to dial numbers into voice mail systems, or to dial phone extensions. See the OnStar Owner's Guide for more information.
Your Responsibility
Increase the volume of the radio if the OnStar advisor cannot be heard.
If the light next to the OnStar buttons is red, the system may not be functioning properly. Press Qand request a vehicle diagnostic. If the light appears clear (no light is appearing), your OnStar subscription has expired and all services have been deactivated. Press Qto confirm that the OnStar equipment is active.
Section 2 Seats and Restraint System
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children
(LATCH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Seat Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Seat Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Airbag System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Restraint System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Crash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Head Restraints
The front seats have adjustable head restraints in the outboard seating positions.
{ WARNING:
With head restraints that are not installed and adjusted properly, there is a greater chance that occupants will suffer a neck/spinal injury in a crash. Do not drive until the head restraints for all occupants are installed and adjusted properly.
Adjust the head restraint so that the top of the restraint is at the same height as the top of the occupant's head. This position reduces the chance of a neck injury in a crash.
Front Seats
Power Seats
Pull the head restraint up to raise it. To lower the head restraint, press the button, located on the top of the seatback, and push the restraint down.
Push down on the head restraint after the button is released to make sure that it is locked in place.
The head restraints are not designed to be removed.
To adjust a power seat:
.Move the seat forward or rearward by sliding the control forward or rearward.
.Raise or lower the front part of the seat cushion by moving the front of the control up or down.
.Raise or lower the rear part of the seat cushion by moving the rear of the control up or down.
.Raise or lower the entire seat by moving the entire control up or down.
For vehicles with power reclining seatbacks, see ???Power Reclining Seatbacks??? under Reclining Seatbacks on page 2??? 9.
Power Lumbar
On vehicles with power lumbar, the control is on the outboard side of the seat.
On vehicles with
On vehicles with
Heated Seats
{ WARNING:
If you cannot feel temperature change or pain to the skin, the seat heater may cause burns even at low temperatures. To reduce the risk of burns, people with such a condition should use care when using the seat heater, especially for long periods of time. Do not place anything on the seat that insulates against heat, such as a blanket, cushion, cover or similar item. This may cause the seat heater to overheat. An overheated seat heater may cause a burn or may damage
the seat.
To operate the heated seats, the ignition must be on.
On vehicles with this feature, the buttons are on the front doors.
Driver Side Buttons Shown
J (Heated Seat Cushion and Seatback): Press to heat the seat and seatback.
I (Heated Seatback) : Press to heat the seatback.
Press the desired button once to turn this feature on at the highest setting. A light on the button turns on to show which feature is on.
The column of three lights near the buttons shows the current temperature setting. With each press of the button, the seat will change to the next lower setting, and then to the off setting. The lights indicate three for the highest setting and one for the lowest.
Remote Start Heated Front Seats
During a remote start, the front heated seats can be turned on automatically. They are canceled when the ignition is turned on. Press the button to use the heated seats after the vehicle is started.
The heated seat indicator lights on the button do not turn on during a remote start.
The temperature performance of an unoccupied seat may be reduced. This is normal.
See Remote Vehicle Start on page 3??? 6 for more information.
Heated and Ventilated Seats
{ WARNING:
If you cannot feel temperature change or pain to the skin, the seat heater may cause burns even at low temperatures. See the Warning under Heated Seats on page 2???5.
To operate the heated and ventilated seats, the ignition must be on.
On vehicles with this feature, the buttons are on the front doors.
Driver Side Buttons Shown
J (Heated Seat Cushion and Seatback): Press to
heat the seat cushion and seatback.
I (Heated Seatback): Press to heat the seatback.
H (Ventilated Seat Cushion and Seatback): Press to
cool the seat cushion and seatback.
Press the desired button once to turn this feature on at the highest setting. A light on the button turns on to show which feature is on.
The column of three lights near the buttons shows the current temperature setting. With each press of the button, the seat will change to the next lower setting, and then to the off setting. The lights indicate three for the highest setting and one for the lowest.
Remote Start Heated Front Seats
During a remote start, the front heated seats can be turned on automatically. They are canceled when the ignition is turned on. Press the button to use the heated seats after the vehicle is started.
The heated seat indicator lights on the button do not turn on during a remote start.
The temperature performance of an unoccupied seat may be reduced. This is normal.
See Remote Vehicle Start on page 3??? 6 for more information.
Memory Seat and Mirrors
On vehicles with the memory feature, the controls on the driver door are used to program and recall memory settings for the driver seat, outside mirrors, and the power steering column, if the vehicle has this feature.
1:Saves and recalls for driver 1.
2:Saves and recalls for driver 2.
S (Easy Exit Positions): Recalls the easy exit driver seat and power steering column positions.
Storing Memory Positions
To save into memory:
1.Adjust the driver seat, seatback recliner, lumbar, both outside mirrors, and the power steering column, if equipped.
2.Press and hold ???1??? until two beeps sound.
3.Repeat for a second driver position using ???2.???
To recall the memory positions, press and release ???1??? or ???2.??? The vehicle must be in P (Park). A single beep will sound. The seat, outside mirrors, and power steering column, if equipped, will move to the positions previously stored for the identified driver.
Memory Remote Recall
The memory feature can recall the driver seat, outside mirrors, and power steering column, if equipped, to stored positions when entering the vehicle.
To activate memory remote recall, unlock the driver door with the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter. The driver seat, outside mirrors, and power steering column will move to the memory positions associated with the transmitter used to unlock the vehicle.
The automatic recall feature can be turned on or off using the vehicle customization menu. See ???Memory Seat Recall??? under DIC Vehicle Customization on page 4???56 for more information.
To stop recall movement, press one of the memory or power mirror buttons, power seat controls, or the power steering column switch.
If something has blocked the driver seat and/or steering column while recalling a memory position, the recall may stop. Remove the obstruction; then press and hold the appropriate manual control for the memory item that is not recalling for two seconds. Try recalling the memory position again by pressing the appropriate memory button. If the memory position is still not recalling, see your dealer for service.
Easy Exit Positions
The easy exit feature can move the driver seat rearward and the power steering column, if equipped, up and forward to allow extra room to exit the vehicle.
S : Press to recall the easy exit positions. The vehicle must be in P (Park).
If the easy exit feature is programmed on in the vehicle customization menu, automatic driver seat and power steering column movement occur when the ignition key is removed.
A single beep sounds. The driver seat will move back and the power steering column, if equipped, moves up and forward.
If something has blocked the driver seat while recalling the exit position, the recall may stop. Remove the obstruction; then press and hold the power seat control rearward for two seconds. Try recalling the exit position again. If the exit position is still not recalling, see your dealer for service.
See ???Easy Exit Recall??? and ???Easy Exit Setup??? under DIC Vehicle Customization on page 4???56 for more information.
Reclining Seatbacks
{ WARNING:
Sitting in a reclined position when the vehicle is in motion can be dangerous. Even when buckled up, the safety belts cannot do their job when reclined like this.
The shoulder belt cannot do its job because it will not be against your body. Instead, it will be in front of you. In a crash, you could go into it, receiving neck or other injuries.
The lap belt cannot do its job either. In a crash, the belt could go up over your abdomen. The belt forces would be there, not at your pelvic bones. This could cause serious internal injuries.
For proper protection when the vehicle is in motion, have the seatback upright. Then sit well back in the seat and wear the safety belt properly.
Do not have the seatback reclined if your vehicle is moving.
Manual Reclining Seatbacks
{ WARNING:
You can lose control of the vehicle if you try to adjust a manual driver seat while the vehicle is moving. The sudden movement could startle and confuse you, or make you push a pedal when you do not want to. Adjust the driver seat only when the vehicle is not moving.
{ WARNING:
If either seatback is not locked, it could move forward in a sudden stop or crash. That could cause injury to the person sitting there. Always push and pull on the seatbacks to be sure they are locked.
If the seats have manual reclining seatbacks, the lever used to operate them is on the outboard side of the seats.
To recline the seatback:
1.Lift the lever.
2.Move the seatback to the desired position, and then release the lever to lock the seatback in place.
3.Push and pull on the seatback to make sure it is locked.
To return the seatback to the upright position:
1.Lift the lever fully without applying pressure to the seatback, and the seatback will return to the upright position.
2.Push and pull on the seatback to make sure it is locked.
Power Reclining Seatbacks
Driver Seat with Power Seat Control, Power Recline, and Power Lumbar Shown
If the seats have power reclining seatbacks, the controls used to operate them are on the outboard side of the seats.
.Tilt the top of the control rearward to recline the seatback.
.Tilt the top of the control forward to raise the seatback.
Center Seat
The vehicle may have a front center seat. This seat can be converted to a storage area by lowering the seatback. See Center Flex Storage Unit on page 3???47.
Rear Seats
Rear Seat
Your vehicle has a pass???through door that provides access to the trunk from the rear seats. See ???Rear Seat Pass???Through Door??? under Trunk on page 3???11.
Safety Belts
Safety Belts: They Are for Everyone
This section of the manual describes how to use safety belts properly. It also describes some things not to do with safety belts.
{ WARNING:
Do not let anyone ride where a safety belt cannot be worn properly. In a crash, if you or your passenger(s) are not wearing safety belts, the injuries can be much worse. You can hit things inside the vehicle harder or be ejected from the vehicle. You and your passenger(s) can be seriously injured or killed. In the same crash, you might not be, if you are buckled up. Always fasten your safety belt, and check that your passenger(s) are restrained properly too.
{ WARNING:
It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area, inside or outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people riding in these areas are more likely to be seriously injured or killed. Do not allow people to ride in any area of your vehicle that is not equipped with seats and safety belts. Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and using a safety belt properly.
This vehicle has indicators as a reminder to buckle the safety belts. See Safety Belt Reminders on page 4???28 for additional information.
In most states and in all Canadian provinces, the law requires wearing safety belts. Here is why:
You never know if you will be in a crash. If you do have a crash, you do not know if it will be a serious one.
A few crashes are mild, and some crashes can be so serious that even buckled up, a person would not survive. But most crashes are in between. In many of them, people who buckle up can survive and sometimes walk away. Without safety belts, they could have been badly hurt or killed.
After more than 40 years of safety belts in vehicles, the facts are clear. In most crashes buckling up does matter ... a lot!
Why Safety Belts Work
When you ride in or on anything, you go as fast as it goes.
Put someone on it.
Take the simplest vehicle. Suppose it is just a seat on wheels.
Get it up to speed. Then stop the vehicle. The rider does not stop.
The person keeps going until stopped by something. In
a real vehicle, it could be the windshield...
Questions and Answers About Safety
Belts
Q:Will I be trapped in the vehicle after a crash if I am wearing a safety belt?
A:You could be ??? whether you are wearing a safety belt or not. But your chance of being conscious during and after an accident, so you can unbuckle and get out, is much greater if you are belted. And you can unbuckle a safety belt, even if you are upside down.
Q:If my vehicle has airbags, why should I have to wear safety belts?
A:Airbags are supplemental systems only; so they work with safety belts ??? not instead of them. Whether or not an airbag is provided, all occupants still have to buckle up to get the most protection. That is true not only in frontal collisions, but especially in side and other collisions.
Q:If I am a good driver, and I never drive far from home, why should I wear safety belts?
A:You may be an excellent driver, but if you are in a crash ??? even one that is not your fault ??? you and your passenger(s) can be hurt. Being a good driver does not protect you from things beyond your control, such as bad drivers.
Most accidents occur within 25 miles (40 km) of home. And the greatest number of serious injuries and deaths occur at speeds of less than 40 mph (65 km/h).
Safety belts are for everyone.
How to Wear Safety Belts Properly
This section is only for people of adult size.
Be aware that there are special things to know about safety belts and children. And there are different rules for smaller children and infants. If a child will be riding in the vehicle, see Older Children on page 2???32 or Infants and Young Children on page 2???35. Follow those rules for everyone's protection.
It is very important for all occupants to buckle up. Statistics show that unbelted people are hurt more often in crashes than those who are wearing safety belts.
Occupants who are not buckled up can be thrown out of the vehicle in a crash. And they can strike others in the vehicle who are wearing safety belts.
First, before you or your passenger(s) wear a safety belt, there is important information you should know.
If you slid under it, the belt would apply force on your abdomen. This could cause serious or even fatal injuries. The shoulder belt should go over the shoulder and across the chest. These parts of the body are best able to take belt restraining forces.
The shoulder belt locks if there is a sudden stop or crash.
Sit up straight and always keep your feet on the floor in front of you. The lap part of the belt should be worn low and snug on the hips, just touching the thighs. In a crash, this applies force to the strong pelvic bones and you would be less likely to slide under the lap belt.
Q: What is wrong with this?
A:The shoulder belt is too loose. It will not give as much protection this way.
{ WARNING:
You can be seriously hurt if your shoulder belt is too loose. In a crash, you would move forward too much, which could increase injury. The shoulder belt should fit snugly against your body.
Q: What is wrong with this?
A:The lap belt is too loose. It will not give nearly as much protection this way.
{ WARNING:
You can be seriously hurt if your lap belt is too loose. In a crash, you could slide under the lap belt and apply force on your abdomen. This could cause serious or even fatal injuries. The lap belt should be worn low and snug on the hips, just touching the thighs.
Q: What is wrong with this?
A: The belt is buckled in the wrong buckle.
{ WARNING:
You can be seriously injured if your belt is buckled in the wrong place like this. In a crash, the belt would go up over your abdomen. The belt forces would be there, not on the pelvic bones. This could cause serious internal injuries. Always buckle your belt into the buckle nearest you.
Q: What is wrong with this?
A: The belt is over an armrest.
{ WARNING:
You can be seriously injured if your belt goes over an armrest like this. The belt would be much too high. In a crash, you can slide under the belt. The belt force would then be applied on the abdomen, not on the pelvic bones, and that could cause serious or fatal injuries. Be sure the belt goes under the armrests.
Q: What is wrong with this?
A:The shoulder belt is worn under the arm. It should be worn over the shoulder at all times.
{ WARNING:
You can be seriously injured if you wear the shoulder belt under your arm. In a crash, your body would move too far forward, which would increase the chance of head and neck injury. Also, the belt would apply too much force to the ribs, which are not as strong as shoulder bones. You could also severely injure internal organs like your liver or spleen. The shoulder belt should go over the shoulder and across the chest.
Q: What is wrong with this?
A: The belt is behind the body.
{ WARNING:
You can be seriously injured by not wearing the
Q: What is wrong with this?
A: The belt is twisted across the body.
{ WARNING:
You can be seriously injured by a twisted belt. In a crash, you would not have the full width of the belt to spread impact forces. If a belt is twisted, make it straight so it can work properly, or ask your dealer to fix it.
All seating positions in the vehicle have a
The following instructions explain how to wear a
1.Adjust the seat, if the seat is adjustable, so you can sit up straight. To see how, see ???Seats??? in the Index.
2.Pick up the latch plate and pull the belt across you. Do not let it get twisted.
The
If the shoulder portion of a passenger belt is pulled out all the way, the child restraint locking feature may be engaged. If this happens, just let the belt go back all the way and start again.
Engaging the child restraint locking feature in the right front seating position may affect the passenger sensing system. See Passenger Sensing System on page 2???65 for more information.
3.Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks.
If the latch plate will not go fully into the buckle, check if the correct buckle is being used.
Pull up on the latch plate to make sure it is secure. If the belt is not long enough, see Safety Belt Extender on page 2???31.
Position the release button on the buckle so that the safety belt could be quickly unbuckled if necessary.
4.If equipped with a shoulder belt height adjuster, move it to the height that is right for you. See ???Shoulder Belt Height Adjuster??? later in this section for instructions on use and important safety information.
5.To make the lap part tight, pull up on the shoulder belt.
It may be necessary to pull stitching on the safety belt through the latch plate to fully tighten the lap belt on smaller occupants.
To unlatch the belt, push the button on the buckle. The belt should return to its stowed position. Slide the latch plate up the safety belt webbing when the safety belt is not in use. The latch plate should rest on the stitching near the guide loop on the side wall.
Before a door is closed, be sure the safety belt is out of the way. If a door is slammed against a safety belt, damage can occur to both the belt and the vehicle.
Shoulder Belt Height Adjuster
The vehicle has a shoulder belt height adjuster for the driver and right front passenger seating positions.
Adjust the height so the shoulder portion of the belt is on the shoulder and not falling off of it. The belt should be close to, but not contacting, the neck. Improper shoulder belt height adjustment could reduce the effectiveness of the safety belt in a crash. See How to Wear Safety Belts Properly on page 2???16.
Press the release button (A) and move the height adjuster to the desired position. The adjuster can be moved up by pushing up on the shoulder belt guide.
After the adjuster is set to the desired position, try to move it down without pressing the release button to make sure it has locked into position.
Safety Belt Pretensioners
This vehicle has safety belt pretensioners for front outboard occupants. Although the safety belt pretensioners cannot be seen, they are part of the safety belt assembly. They can help tighten the safety belts during the early stages of a moderate to severe frontal or near frontal crash if the threshold conditions for pretensioner activation are met. And, if your vehicle has side impact airbags, safety belt pretensioners can help tighten the safety belts in a side crash.
Pretensioners work only once. If the pretensioners activate in a crash, they will need to be replaced, and probably other new parts for the vehicle's safety belt system. See Replacing Restraint System Parts After a Crash on page 2???73.
Rear Safety Belt Comfort Guides
This vehicle may have rear shoulder belt comfort guides for each outside passenger position in the rear seat.
If not, they are available through your dealer. The guides may provide added safety belt comfort for older children who have outgrown booster seats and for some adults. When installed the comfort guide positions the shoulder belt away from the neck and head.
Here is how to install a comfort guide to the safety belt:
1.Remove the guide from its storage pocket on the rear side of the seatback.
2.Place the guide over the belt, and insert the two edges of the belt into the slots of the guide.
3.Be sure that the belt is not twisted and it lies flat. The elastic cord must be under the belt and the guide on top.
{ WARNING:
A safety belt that is not properly worn may not provide the protection needed in a crash. The person wearing the belt could be seriously injured. The shoulder belt should go over the shoulder and across the chest. These parts of the body are best able to take belt restraining forces.
4.Buckle, position, and release the safety belt as described previously in this section. Make sure the shoulder portion of the belt is on the shoulder and not falling off of it. The belt should be close to, but not contacting, the neck.
To remove and store the comfort guide, squeeze the belt edges together so that the safety belt can be removed from the guide. Slide the guide into its storage pocket on the side of the seatback.
Safety Belt Use During Pregnancy
Safety belts work for everyone, including pregnant women. Like all occupants, they are more likely to be seriously injured if they do not wear safety belts.
A pregnant woman should wear a
The best way to protect the fetus is to protect the mother. When a safety belt is worn properly, it is more likely that the fetus will not be hurt in a crash. For pregnant women, as for anyone, the key to making safety belts effective is wearing them properly.
Lap Belt
This part is only for the lap belt. To learn how to wear a
The vehicle may have a center seating position. When you sit in the center front seating position, you have a lap safety belt, which has no retractor.
To make the belt longer, tilt the latch plate and pull it along the belt.
Buckle, position and release it the same way as the lap part of a
To make the belt shorter, pull its free end as shown until the belt is snug.
If the belt is not long enough, see Safety Belt Extender on page 2???31.
Make sure the release button on the buckle is positioned so you would be able to unbuckle the safety belt quickly if necessary.
If you find that the latch plate will not go fully into the buckle, see if you are using the correct buckle. Be sure that the latch plate clicks when inserted into the buckle.
Safety Belt Extender
If the vehicle's safety belt will fasten around you, you should use it.
But if a safety belt is not long enough, your dealer will order you an extender. When you go in to order it, take the heaviest coat you will wear, so the extender will be long enough for you. To help avoid personal injury, do not let someone else use it, and use it only for the seat it is made to fit. The extender has been designed for adults. Never use it for securing child seats. To wear it, attach it to the regular safety belt. For more information, see the instruction sheet that comes with the extender.
Child Restraints
Older Children
Older children who have outgrown booster seats should wear the vehicle's safety belts.
The manufacturer's instructions that come with the booster seat, state the weight and height limitations for that booster. Use a booster seat with a
.Sit all the way back on the seat. Do the knees bend at the seat edge? If yes, continue. If no, return to the booster seat.
.Buckle the
.Does the lap belt fit low and snug on the hips, touching the thighs? If yes, continue. If no, return to the booster seat.
.Can proper safety belt fit be maintained for length of trip? If yes, continue. If no, return to the booster seat.
If you have the choice, a child should sit in a position with a
Q: What is the proper way to wear safety belts?
A:An older child should wear a
It should never be worn over the abdomen, which could cause severe or even fatal internal injuries in a crash.
Also see ???Rear Safety Belt Comfort Guides??? under
According to accident statistics, children and infants are safer when properly restrained in a child restraint system or infant restraint system secured in a rear seating position.
In a crash, children who are not buckled up can strike other people who are buckled up, or can be thrown out of the vehicle. Older children need to use safety belts properly.
{ WARNING:
Never do this.
Never allow two children to wear the same safety belt. The safety belt can not properly spread the impact forces. In a crash, the two children can be crushed together and seriously injured. A safety belt must be used by only one person at a time.
{ WARNING:
Never do this.
Never allow a child to wear the safety belt with the shoulder belt behind their back. A child can be seriously injured by not wearing the
Infants and Young Children
Everyone in a vehicle needs protection! This includes infants and all other children. Neither the distance traveled nor the age and size of the traveler changes the need, for everyone, to use safety restraints. In fact, the law in every state in the United States and in every Canadian province says children up to some age must be restrained while in a vehicle.
{ WARNING:
Children can be seriously injured or strangled if a shoulder belt is wrapped around their neck and the safety belt continues to tighten. Never leave children unattended in a vehicle and never allow children to play with the safety belts.
Airbags plus lap???shoulder belts offer protection for adults and older children, but not for young children and infants. Neither the vehicle's safety belt system nor its airbag system is designed for them. Every time infants and young children ride in vehicles, they should have the protection provided by appropriate child restraints.
Children who are not restrained properly can strike other people, or can be thrown out of the vehicle.
{ WARNING:
Never do this.
Never hold an infant or a child while riding in a vehicle. Due to crash forces, an infant or a child will become so heavy it is not possible to hold it during a crash. For example, in a crash at only 40 km/h (25 mph), a 5.5 kg (12 lb) infant will suddenly become a 110 kg (240 lb) force on a person's arms. An infant should be secured in an appropriate restraint.
{ WARNING:
Never do this.
Children who are up against, or very close to, any airbag when it inflates can be seriously injured or killed. Never put a
Q:What are the different types of
A:
be used.
For most basic types of child restraints, there are many different models available. When purchasing a child restraint, be sure it is designed to be used in a motor vehicle. If it is, the restraint will have a label saying that it meets federal motor vehicle safety standards.
The restraint manufacturer's instructions that come with the restraint state the weight and height limitations for a particular child restraint. In addition, there are many kinds of restraints available for children with special needs.
{ WARNING:
To reduce the risk of neck and head injury during a crash, infants need complete support. This is because an infant's neck is not fully developed
(Continued)
WARNING: (Continued)
and its head weighs so much compared with the rest of its body. In a crash, an infant in a
{ WARNING:
A young child's hip bones are still so small that the vehicle's regular safety belt may not remain low on the hip bones, as it should. Instead, it may settle up around the child's abdomen. In a crash, the belt would apply force on a body area that is unprotected by any bony structure. This alone could cause serious or fatal injuries. To reduce the risk of serious or fatal injuries during a crash, young children should always be secured in appropriate child restraints.
Child Restraint Systems
A
seat (A) provides restraint with the seating surface against the back of the infant.
The harness system holds the infant in place and, in a crash, acts to keep the infant positioned in the restraint.
A
Abooster seat
Abooster seat can also help a child to see out the window.
Securing an
the Vehicle
{ WARNING:
A child can be seriously injured or killed in a crash if the child restraint is not properly secured in the vehicle. Secure the child restraint properly in the vehicle using the vehicle's safety belt or LATCH system, following the instructions that came with that child restraint and the instructions in this manual.
To help reduce the chance of injury, the child restraint must be secured in the vehicle. Child restraint systems must be secured in vehicle seats by lap belts or the lap belt portion of a
When securing an
Keep in mind that an unsecured child restraint can move around in a collision or sudden stop and injure people in the vehicle. Be sure to properly secure any child restraint in the vehicle ??? even when no child is in it.
In some areas, Certified Child Passenger Safety Technicians (CPSTs) are available to inspect and demonstrate how to correctly use and install child restraints. In the U.S., refer to the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) website to locate the nearest child safety seat inspection station. For CPST availability in Canada, check with Transport Canada or the Provincial Ministry of Transportation office.
Securing the Child Within the Child
Restraint
{ WARNING:
A child can be seriously injured or killed in a crash if the child is not properly secured in the child restraint. Secure the child properly following the instructions that came with that child restraint.
Where to Put the Restraint
According to accident statistics, children and infants are safer when properly restrained in a child restraint system or infant restraint system secured in a rear seating position.
We recommend that children and child restraints be secured in a rear seat, including: an infant or a child riding in a
A label on your sun visor says, ???Never put a
{ WARNING:
A child in a
Even if the passenger sensing system has turned off the right front passenger frontal airbag, no system is
Secure
(Continued)
WARNING: (Continued)
always move the front passenger seat as far back as it will go. It is better to secure the child restraint in a rear seat.
See Passenger Sensing System on page 2???65 for additional information.
{ WARNING:
A child in a child restraint in the center front seat can be badly injured or killed by the frontal airbags if they inflate. Never secure a child restraint in the center front seat. It is always better to secure a child restraint in a rear seat.
Do not use child restraints in the center front seat position.
When securing a child restraint in a rear seating position, study the instructions that came with your child restraint to make sure it is compatible with this vehicle.
Child restraints and booster seats vary considerably in size, and some may fit in certain seating positions better than others. Always make sure the child restraint is properly secured.
Depending on where you place the child restraint and the size of the child restraint, you may not be able to access adjacent safety belt assemblies or LATCH anchors for additional passengers or child restraints. Adjacent seating positions should not be used if the child restraint prevents access to or interferes with the routing of the safety belt.
Wherever a child restraint is installed, be sure to secure the child restraint properly.
Keep in mind that an unsecured child restraint can move around in a collision or sudden stop and injure people in the vehicle. Be sure to properly secure any child restraint in your vehicle ??? even when no child is in it.
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH)
The LATCH system holds a child restraint during driving or in a crash. This system is designed to make installation of a child restraint easier. The LATCH system uses anchors in the vehicle and attachments on the child restraint that are made for use with the LATCH system.
Make sure that a
In order to use the LATCH system in your vehicle, you need a child restraint that has LATCH attachments. The child restraint manufacturer will provide you with instructions on how to use the child restraint and its attachments. The following explains how to attach a child restraint with these attachments in your vehicle.
Not all vehicle seating positions or child restraints have lower anchors and attachments or top tether anchors and attachments.
Lower anchors (A) are metal bars built into the vehicle. There are two lower anchors for each LATCH seating position that will accommodate a child restraint with lower attachments (B).
A top tether (A, C) anchors the top of the child restraint to the vehicle. A top tether anchor is built into the vehicle. The top tether attachment (B) on the child restraint connects to the top tether anchor in the vehicle in order to reduce the forward movement and rotation of the child restraint during driving or in a crash.
Your child restraint may have a single tether (A) or a dual tether (C). Either will have a single attachment (B) to secure the top tether to the anchor.
Some child restraints that have a top tether are designed for use with or without the top tether being attached. Others require the top tether always to be attached. In Canada, the law requires that
Lower Anchor and Top Tether Anchor
Locations
i (Top Tether Anchor): Seating positions with top tether anchors.
j (Lower Anchor): Seating positions with two lower anchors.
Rear Seat
To assist you in locating the lower anchors, each seating position with lower anchors has two labels, near the crease between the seatback and the seat cushion.
To assist you in locating the top tether anchors, the top tether anchor symbol is located on the cover.
The top tether anchors are located under the covers on the rear seatback filler panel. Flip open the cover to access the anchors. Be sure to use an anchor located on the same side of the vehicle as the seating position where the child restraint will be placed.
Do not secure a child restraint in a position without a top tether anchor if a national or local law requires that the top tether be attached, or if the instructions that come with the child restraint say that the top tether must be attached.
According to accident statistics, children and infants are safer when properly restrained in a child restraint system or infant restraint system secured in a rear seating position. See Where to Put the Restraint on page 2???41 for additional information.
Securing a Child Restraint Designed for the LATCH System
{ WARNING:
If a
{ WARNING:
Do not attach more than one child restraint to a single anchor. Attaching more than one child restraint to a single anchor could cause the anchor or attachment to come loose or even break during a crash. A child or others could be injured. To reduce the risk of serious or fatal injuries during a crash, attach only one child restraint per anchor.
{ WARNING:
Children can be seriously injured or strangled if a shoulder belt is wrapped around their neck and the safety belt continues to tighten. Buckle any unused safety belts behind the child restraint so children cannot reach them. Pull the shoulder belt all the way out of the retractor to set the lock,
if your vehicle has one, after the child restraint has been installed.
Notice: Do not let the LATCH attachments rub against the vehicle???s safety belts. This may damage these parts. If necessary, move buckled safety belts to avoid rubbing the LATCH attachments.
Do not fold the empty rear seat with a safety belt buckled. This could damage the safety belt or the seat. Unbuckle and return the safety belt to its stowed position, before folding the seat.
1.Attach and tighten the lower attachments to the lower anchors. If the child restraint does not have lower attachments or the desired seating position does not have lower anchors, secure the child restraint with the top tether and the safety belts. Refer to your child restraint manufacturer instructions and the instructions in this manual.
1.1. Find the lower anchors for the desired seating position.
1. 2. Put the child restraint on the seat.
1.3. Attach and tighten the lower attachments on the child restraint to the lower anchors.
2.If the child restraint manufacturer recommends that the top tether be attached, attach and tighten the top tether to the top tether anchor, if equipped. Refer to the child restraint instructions and the following steps:
2. 1. Find the top tether anchor.
2.2. Flip open the top tether anchor cover to expose the anchor.
2.3. Route, attach, and tighten the top tether according to your child restraint instructions and the following instructions:
If the position you are using does not have a headrest or head restraint and you are using a single tether, route the tether over the seatback.
If the position you are using does not have a headrest or head restraint and you are using a dual tether, route the tether over the seatback.
If the position you are using has a fixed headrest or head restraint and you are using a single tether, route the tether over the headrest or head restraint.
If the position you are using has a fixed headrest or head restraint and you are using a dual tether, route the tether around the headrest or head restraint.
3.Before placing a child in the child restraint, make sure it is securely held in place. To check, grasp the child restraint at the LATCH path and attempt to move it side???to???side and back???and???forth. There should be no more than 2.5 cm (1 in) of movement for proper installation.
Securing a Child Restraint in a Rear
Seat Position
When securing a child restraint in a rear seating position, study the instructions that came with the child restraint to make sure it is compatible with this vehicle.
If the child restraint has the LATCH system, see Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH) on
page 2???43 for how and where to install the child restraint using LATCH. If a child restraint is secured in
the vehicle using a safety belt and it uses a top tether, see Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH) on page 2???43 for top tether anchor locations.
Do not secure a child seat in a position without a top tether anchor if a national or local law requires that the top tether be anchored, or if the instructions that come with the child restraint say that the top strap must be anchored.
In Canada, the law requires that
If the child restraint does not have the LATCH system, you will be using the safety belt to secure the child restraint in this position. Be sure to follow the instructions that came with the child restraint. Secure the child in the child restraint when and as the instructions say.
If more than one child restraint needs to be installed in the rear seat, be sure to read Where to Put the Restraint on page 2???41.
1.Put the child restraint on the seat.
2.Pick up the latch plate, and run the lap and shoulder portions of the vehicle's safety belt through or around the restraint. The child restraint instructions will show you how.
3.Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks.
Position the release button on the buckle so that the safety belt could be quickly unbuckled if necessary.
4.Pull the shoulder belt all the way out of the retractor to set the lock. When the retractor lock is set, the belt can be tightened but not pulled out of the retractor.
5.To tighten the belt, push down on the child restraint, pull the shoulder portion of the belt to tighten the lap portion of the belt, and feed the shoulder belt back into the retractor. When installing a
Try to pull the belt out of the retractor to make sure the retractor is locked. If the retractor is not locked, repeat Steps 4 and 5.
6.If the child restraint has a top tether, follow the child restraint manufacturer's instructions regarding the use of the top tether. See Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH) on page 2???43 for more information.
7.Before placing a child in the child restraint, make sure it is securely held in place. To check, grasp the child restraint at the safety belt path and attempt to move it side???to???side and back???and???forth. When the child restraint is properly installed, there should be no more than 2.5 cm (1 in) of movement.
To remove the child restraint, unbuckle the vehicle safety belt and let it return to the stowed position. If the top tether is attached to a top tether anchor, disconnect it.
Securing a Child Restraint in the
Center Front Seat Position
{ WARNING:
A child in a child restraint in the center front seat can be badly injured or killed by the frontal airbags if they inflate. Never secure a child restraint in the center front seat. It is always better to secure a child restraint in a rear seat.
Do not use child restraints in the center front seat position.
Securing a Child Restraint in the
Right Front Seat Position
This vehicle has airbags. A rear seat is a safer place to secure a
In addition, the vehicle has a passenger sensing system which is designed to turn off the right front passenger frontal airbag and
System on page 4???30 and Passenger Airbag Status Indicator on page 4???30 for more information, including important safety information.
A label on the sun visor says, ???Never put a
{ WARNING:
A child in a
Even if the passenger sensing system has turned off the right front passenger frontal airbag, no system is
(Continued)
WARNING: (Continued)
Secure
See Passenger Sensing System on page 2???65 for additional information.
If the child restraint has the LATCH system, see Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH) on
page 2???43 for how and where to install the child restraint using LATCH. If a child restraint is secured using a safety belt and it uses a top tether, see Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH) on
page 2???43 for top tether anchor locations.
Do not secure a child seat in a position without a top tether anchor if a national or local law requires that the top tether be anchored, or if the instructions that come with the child restraint say that the top strap must be anchored.
In Canada, the law requires that
You will be using the
1.Move the seat as far back as it will go before securing the
When the passenger sensing system has turned off the right front passenger frontal airbag and
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator on page 4???30.
2.Put the child restraint on the seat.
3.Pick up the latch plate, and run the lap and shoulder portions of the vehicle's safety belt through or around the restraint. The child restraint instructions will show you how.
4.Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks.
Position the release button on the buckle so that the safety belt could be quickly unbuckled if necessary.
5.Pull the shoulder belt all the way out of the retractor to set the lock. When the retractor lock is set, the belt can be tightened but not pulled out of the retractor.
6.To tighten the belt, push down on the child restraint, pull the shoulder portion of the belt to tighten the lap portion of the belt, and feed the shoulder belt back into the retractor. When installing a
Try to pull the belt out of the retractor to make sure the retractor is locked. If the retractor is not locked, repeat Steps 5 and 6.
7.Before placing a child in the child restraint, make sure it is securely held in place. To check, grasp the child restraint at the safety belt path and attempt to move it side???to???side and back???and???forth. When the child restraint is properly installed, there should be no more than 2.5 cm (1 in) of movement.
If the airbags are off, the off indicator in the passenger airbag status indicator will come on and stay on when the vehicle is started.
If a child restraint has been installed and the on indicator is lit, see ???If the On Indicator is Lit for a Child Restraint ??? under Passenger Sensing System on page 2???65 for more information.
To remove the child restraint, unbuckle the vehicle safety belt and let it return to the stowed position.
Airbag System
The vehicle has the following airbags:
.A frontal airbag for the driver.
.A frontal airbag for the right front passenger.
.A
.A
.A
.A
All of the airbags in your vehicle will have the word AIRBAG embossed in the trim or on an attached label near the deployment opening.
For frontal airbags, the word AIRBAG will appear on the middle part of the steering wheel for the driver and on the instrument panel for the right front passenger.
With
With
Airbags are designed to supplement the protection provided by safety belts. Even though today's airbags are also designed to help reduce the risk of injury from the force of an inflating bag, all airbags must inflate very quickly to do their job.
Here are the most important things to know about the airbag system:
{ WARNING:
You can be severely injured or killed in a crash if you are not wearing your safety belt ??? even if you have airbags. Airbags are designed to work with safety belts, but do not replace them. Also, airbags are not designed to deploy in every crash. In some crashes safety belts are your only restraint. See When Should an Airbag Inflate? on page 2???61.
Wearing your safety belt during a crash helps reduce your chance of hitting things inside the vehicle or being ejected from it. Airbags are ???supplemental restraints??? to the safety belts. Everyone in your vehicle should wear a safety belt properly ??? whether or not there is an airbag for that person.
{ WARNING:
Airbags inflate with great force, faster than the blink of an eye. Anyone who is up against, or very close to, any airbag when it inflates can be seriously injured or killed. Do not sit unnecessarily close to the airbag, as you would be if you were sitting on the edge of your seat or leaning forward. Safety belts help keep you in position before and during a crash. Always wear your safety belt, even with airbags. The driver should sit as far back as possible while still maintaining control of the vehicle.
Occupants should not lean on or sleep against the door or side windows in seating positions with
{ WARNING:
Children who are up against, or very close to, any airbag when it inflates can be seriously injured or killed. Airbags plus
There is an airbag readiness light on the instrument panel cluster, which shows the airbag symbol.
The system checks the airbag electrical system for malfunctions. The light tells you if there is an electrical problem. See Airbag Readiness Light on page 4???29 for more information.
Where Are the Airbags?
The right front passenger frontal airbag is in the
instrument panel on the passenger side.
The driver frontal airbag is in the middle of the steering wheel.
Driver Side shown, Passenger Side similar
The
Driver Side shown, Passenger Side similar
The
{ WARNING:
If something is between an occupant and an airbag, the airbag might not inflate properly or it might force the object into that person causing severe injury or even death. The path of an inflating airbag must be kept clear. Do not put anything between an occupant and an airbag, and do not attach or put anything on the steering wheel hub or on or near any other airbag covering.
Do not use seat accessories that block the inflation path of a
Never secure anything to the roof of a vehicle with
When Should an Airbag Inflate?
Frontal airbags are designed to inflate in moderate to severe frontal or
Whether your frontal airbags will or should deploy is not based on how fast your vehicle is traveling. It depends largely on what you hit, the direction of the impact, and how quickly your vehicle slows down.
Frontal airbags may inflate at different crash speeds. For example:
.If the vehicle hits a stationary object, the airbags could inflate at a different crash speed than if the vehicle hits a moving object.
.If the vehicle hits an object that deforms, the airbags could inflate at a different crash speed than if the vehicle hits an object that does not deform.
.If the vehicle hits a narrow object (like a pole), the airbags could inflate at a different crash speed than if the vehicle hits a wide object (like a wall).
.If the vehicle goes into an object at an angle, the airbags could inflate at a different crash speed than if the vehicle goes straight into the object.
Thresholds can also vary with specific vehicle design.
Frontal airbags are not intended to inflate during vehicle rollovers, rear impacts, or in many side impacts.
Your vehicle has a seat position sensor which enables the sensing system to monitor the position of the right front passenger's seat. The passenger seat position sensor and passenger safety belt buckle switch provide information that is used to determine if the airbags should deploy at a reduced level or at full deployment.
In addition, your vehicle has a
Your vehicle also has a
front passenger seat. The passenger airbag inflates to a reduced depth when the passenger seat is in a forward position. For more rearward front seating positions, the passenger airbag may inflate to an increased depth (a full deployment), based on safety belt status and the crash severity measured early in the event. (Always wear your safety belt, even with frontal airbags.)
Your vehicle has
In any particular crash, no one can say whether an airbag should have inflated simply because of the damage to a vehicle or because of what the repair costs were. For frontal airbags, inflation is determined by what the vehicle hits, the angle of the impact, and how quickly the vehicle slows down. For
What Makes an Airbag Inflate?
In a deployment event, the sensing system sends an electrical signal triggering a release of gas from the inflator. Gas from the inflator fills the airbag causing the bag to break out of the cover and deploy. The inflator, the airbag, and related hardware are all part of the airbag module.
Frontal airbag modules are located inside the steering wheel and instrument panel. For vehicles with
How Does an Airbag Restrain?
In moderate to severe frontal or near frontal collisions, even belted occupants can contact the steering wheel or the instrument panel. In moderate to severe side collisions, even belted occupants can contact the inside of the vehicle.
Airbags supplement the protection provided by safety belts. Frontal airbags distribute the force of the impact more evenly over the occupant's upper body, stopping the occupant more gradually.
But airbags would not help in many types of collisions, primarily because the occupant's motion is not toward those airbags. See When Should an Airbag Inflate? on page 2???61 for more information.
Airbags should never be regarded as anything more than a supplement to safety belts.
What Will You See After an Airbag
Inflates?
After the frontal airbags and
The parts of the airbag that come into contact with you may be warm, but not too hot to touch. There may be some smoke and dust coming from the vents in the deflated airbags. Airbag inflation does not prevent the driver from seeing out of the windshield or being able to steer the vehicle, nor does it prevent people from leaving the vehicle.
{ WARNING:
When an airbag inflates, there may be dust in the air. This dust could cause breathing problems for people with a history of asthma or other breathing trouble. To avoid this, everyone in the vehicle should get out as soon as it is safe to do so.
(Continued)
WARNING: (Continued)
If you have breathing problems but cannot get out of the vehicle after an airbag inflates, then get fresh air by opening a window or a door. If you experience breathing problems following an airbag deployment, you should seek medical attention.
The vehicle has a feature that may automatically unlock the doors, turn on the interior lamps and hazard warning flashers, and shut off the fuel system after the airbags inflate. You can lock the doors, turn off the interior lamps and hazard warning flashers by using the controls for those features.
{ WARNING:
A crash severe enough to inflate the airbags may have also damaged important functions in the vehicle, such as the fuel system, brake and steering systems, etc. Even if the vehicle appears to be drivable after a moderate crash, there may be concealed damage that could make it difficult to safely operate the vehicle.
(Continued)
WARNING: (Continued)
Use caution if you should attempt to restart the engine after a crash has occurred.
In many crashes severe enough to inflate the airbag, windshields are broken by vehicle deformation. Additional windshield breakage may also occur from the right front passenger airbag.
.Airbags are designed to inflate only once. After an airbag inflates, you will need some new parts for the airbag system. If you do not get them, the airbag system will not be there to help protect you in another crash. A new system will include airbag modules and possibly other parts. The service manual for your vehicle covers the need to replace other parts.
.The vehicle has a crash sensing and diagnostic module which records information after a crash. See Vehicle Data Recording and Privacy on page 8???15 and Event Data Recorders on page 8???16.
.Let only qualified technicians work on the airbag systems. Improper service can mean that an airbag system will not work properly. See your dealer for service.
Passenger Sensing System
The vehicle has a passenger sensing system for the right front passenger position. The passenger airbag status indicator will be visible on the overhead console when the vehicle is started.
The words ON and OFF, or the symbol for on and off, are visible during the system check. If you are using remote start, if equipped, to start the vehicle from a distance, you may not see the system check. When the system check is complete, either the word ON or OFF, or the symbol for on or off, will be visible. See
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator on page 4???30.
The passenger sensing system turns off the right front passenger frontal airbag and
The passenger sensing system works with sensors that are part of the right front passenger seat. The sensors are designed to detect the presence of a
According to accident statistics, children are safer when properly secured in a rear seat in the correct child restraint for their weight and size.
We recommend that children be secured in a rear seat, including: an infant or a child riding in a
A label on the sun visor says, ???Never put a
{ WARNING:
A child in a
Even if the passenger sensing system has turned off the right front passenger frontal airbag and
Secure
The passenger sensing system is designed to turn off the right front passenger airbag and seat???mounted side impact airbag if:
.The right front passenger seat is unoccupied.
.The system determines that an infant is present in a
.The system determines that a small child is present in a child restraint.
.The system determines that a small child is present in a booster seat.
.A right front passenger takes his/her weight off of the seat for a period of time.
.The right front passenger seat is occupied by a smaller person, such as a child who has outgrown child restraints.
.Or, if there is a critical problem with the airbag system or the passenger sensing system.
When the passenger sensing system has turned off the right front passenger frontal airbag and seat???mounted side impact airbag, the off indicator will light and stay lit to remind you that the airbags are off. See Passenger Airbag Status Indicator on page 4???30.
The passenger sensing system is designed to turn on (may inflate) the right front passenger frontal airbag and seat???mounted side impact airbag anytime the system senses that a person of adult size is sitting properly in the right front passenger seat.
When the passenger sensing system has allowed the airbags to be enabled, the on indicator will light and stay lit to remind you that the airbags are active.
For some children who have outgrown child restraints and for very small adults, the passenger sensing system may or may not turn off the right front passenger frontal airbag and
{ WARNING:
If the airbag readiness light ever comes on and stays on, it means that something may be wrong with the airbag system. To help avoid injury to yourself or others, have the vehicle serviced right away. See Airbag Readiness Light on page 4???29 for more information, including important safety information.
If the On Indicator is Lit for a Child Restraint
If a child restraint has been installed and the on indicator is lit:
1.Turn the vehicle off.
2.Remove the child restraint from the vehicle.
3.Remove any additional items from the seat such as blankets, cushions, seat covers, seat heaters,
or seat massagers.
4.Reinstall the child restraint following the directions provided by the child restraint manufacturer and refer to Securing a Child Restraint in the Right Front Seat Position on page 2???52.
5.If, after reinstalling the child restraint and restarting the vehicle, the on indicator is still lit, turn the vehicle off. Then slightly recline the vehicle seatback and adjust the seat cushion, if adjustable, to make sure that the vehicle seatback is not pushing the child restraint into the seat cushion.
Also make sure the child restraint is not trapped under the vehicle head restraint. If this happens, adjust the head restraint. See Head Restraints on page 2??? 2.
6.Restart the vehicle.
If the on indicator is still lit, secure the child in the child restraint in a rear seat position in the vehicle, and check with your dealer.
If the Off Indicator is Lit for an
If a person of
If this happens, use the following steps to allow the system to detect that person and enable the right front passenger frontal airbag and
1.Turn the vehicle off.
2.Remove any additional material from the seat, such as blankets, cushions, seat covers, seat heaters, or seat massagers.
3.Place the seatback in the fully upright position.
4.Have the person sit upright in the seat, centered on the seat cushion, with legs comfortably extended.
5.Restart the vehicle and have the person remain in this position for two to three minutes after the on indicator is lit.
Additional Factors Affecting System
Operation
Safety belts help keep the passenger in position on the seat during vehicle maneuvers and braking, which helps the passenger sensing system maintain the passenger airbag status. See ???Safety Belts??? and ???Child Restraints??? in the Index for additional information about the importance of proper restraint use.
A thick layer of additional material, such as a blanket or cushion, or aftermarket equipment such as seat covers, seat heaters, and seat massagers can affect how well the passenger sensing system operates. We recommend that you not use seat covers or other aftermarket equipment except when approved by GM for your specific vehicle. See Adding Equipment to Your
{ WARNING:
Stowing of articles under the passenger seat or between the passenger seat cushion and seatback may interfere with the proper operation of the passenger sensing system.
Servicing Your
Vehicle
Airbags affect how the vehicle should be serviced. There are parts of the airbag system in several places around the vehicle. Your dealer and the service manual have information about servicing the vehicle and the airbag system. To purchase a service manual, see
Service Publications Ordering Information on page 8???14.
{ WARNING:
For up to 10 seconds after the ignition is turned off and the battery is disconnected, an airbag can still inflate during improper service. You can be injured if you are close to an airbag when it inflates. Avoid yellow connectors. They are probably part of the airbag system. Be sure to follow proper service procedures, and make sure the person performing work for you is qualified to do so.
Adding Equipment to Your
Q:Is there anything I might add to or change about the vehicle that could keep the airbags from working properly?
A:Yes. If you add things that change your vehicle's frame, bumper system, height, front end or side sheet metal, they may keep the airbag system from working properly. Changing or moving any parts of the front seats, safety belts, the airbag sensing and diagnostic module, steering wheel, instrument panel,
In addition, your vehicle has a passenger sensing system for the right front passenger's position, which includes sensors that are part of the passenger's seat. The passenger sensing system may not operate properly if the original seat trim is replaced with
installed under or on top of the seat fabric, could also interfere with the operation of the passenger sensing system. This could either prevent proper deployment of the passenger airbag(s) or prevent the passenger sensing system from properly turning off the passenger airbag(s). See Passenger Sensing System on page 2???65.
If you have any questions about this, you should contact Customer Assistance before you modify your vehicle. The phone numbers and addresses for Customer Assistance are in Step Two of the Customer Satisfaction Procedure in this manual. See Customer Satisfaction Procedure on page 8???2.
Q:Because I have a disability, I have to get my vehicle modified. How can I find out whether this will affect my airbag system?
A:If you have questions, call Customer Assistance. The phone numbers and addresses for Customer Assistance are in Step Two of the Customer Satisfaction Procedure in this manual. See
Customer Satisfaction Procedure on page 8???2.
In addition, your dealer and the service manual have information about the location of the airbag sensors, sensing and diagnostic module and airbag wiring.
Restraint System Check
Checking the Restraint Systems
Safety Belts
Now and then, check that the safety belt reminder light, safety belts, buckles, latch plates, retractors, and anchorages are all working properly.
Look for any other loose or damaged safety belt system parts that might keep a safety belt system from doing its job. See your dealer to have it repaired. Torn or frayed safety belts may not protect you in a crash. They can rip apart under impact forces. If a belt is torn or frayed, get a new one right away.
Make sure the safety belt reminder light is working. See
Safety Belt Reminders on page 4???28 for more information.
Keep safety belts clean and dry. See Care of Safety Belts on page 6???100.
Airbags
The airbag system does not need regularly scheduled maintenance or replacement. Make sure the airbag readiness light is working. See Airbag Readiness Light on page 4???29 for more information.
Notice: If an airbag covering is damaged, opened, or broken, the airbag may not work properly. Do not open or break the airbag coverings. If there are any opened or broken airbag covers, have the airbag covering and/or airbag module replaced. For the location of the airbag modules, see What Makes an Airbag Inflate? on page 2???63. See your dealer for service.
Replacing Restraint System Parts
After a Crash
{ WARNING:
A crash can damage the restraint systems in your vehicle. A damaged restraint system may not properly protect the person using it, resulting in serious injury or even death in a crash. To help make sure your restraint systems are working properly after a crash, have them inspected and any necessary replacements made as soon as possible.
If the vehicle has been in a crash, do you need new safety belts or LATCH system (if equipped) parts?
After a very minor crash, nothing may be necessary. But the safety belt assemblies that were used during any crash may have been stressed or damaged. See your dealer to have the safety belt assemblies inspected or replaced.
If the vehicle has the LATCH system and it was being used during a crash, you may need new LATCH system parts.
New parts and repairs may be necessary even if the safety belt or LATCH system (if equipped), was not being used at the time of the crash.
If an airbag inflates, you will need to replace airbag system parts. See the part on the airbag system earlier in this section.
Have the safety belt pretensioners checked if the vehicle has been in a crash, if the airbag readiness light stays on after the vehicle is started, or while you are driving. See Airbag Readiness Light on page 4???29.
2 NOTES
Section 3 Features and Controls
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System . . . . . . . . . . .
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Remote Vehicle Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Doors and Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Delayed Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Programmable Automatic Door Locks . . . . . . . . . .
Rear Door Security Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Lockout Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Trunk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Sun Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Content
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Starting and Operating Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . .
New Vehicle
Ignition Positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Starting the Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Engine Coolant Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Automatic Transmission Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Shifting Into Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Shifting Out of Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Parking Over Things That Burn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Engine Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Running the Vehicle While Parked . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror . . . . . . . . . . .
Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Outside Power Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Outside Automatic Dimming Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Park Tilt Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Outside Convex Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Outside Heated Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Section 3 Features and Controls
Keys
{ WARNING:
Leaving children in a vehicle with the ignition key is dangerous for many reasons. Children or others could be badly injured or even killed. They could operate the power windows or other controls or even make the vehicle move. The windows will function with the keys in the ignition and children could be seriously injured or killed if caught in the path of a closing window. Do not leave the keys in a vehicle with children.
The key can be used for the ignition, the driver's door, and the glovebox lock.
The key has a
See your dealer if a replacement key or additional key is needed.
Notice: If the keys get locked in the vehicle, it may have to be damaged to get them out. Always carry a spare key.
If you are locked out of your vehicle, contact Roadside Assistance. See Roadside Assistance Program on page 8??? 7 for more information.
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System
See Radio Frequency Statement on page 8???17 for information regarding Part 15 of the Federal Communications Commission (FCC) rules and Industry Canada Standards
If there is a decrease in the RKE operating range, try this:
.Check the distance. The transmitter may be too far from the vehicle. Stand closer during rainy or snowy weather.
.Check the location. Other vehicles or objects may be blocking the signal. Take a few steps to the left or right, hold the transmitter higher, and try again.
.Check the transmitter's battery. See ???Battery Replacement??? later in this section.
.If the transmitter is still not working correctly, see your dealer or a qualified technician for service.
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System
Operation
The Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter functions work up to 60 m (195 feet) away from the vehicle.
There are other conditions which can affect the performance of the transmitter. See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System on page 3???4.
With Remote Start Shown,
Without Remote Start
Similar
/ (Remote Vehicle Start): For vehicles with this feature, press to start the engine from outside the vehicle using the RKE transmitter. See Remote Vehicle Start on page 3??? 6 for additional information.
Q (Lock): Press to lock all the doors. If enabled through the Driver Information Center (DIC), the parking lamps flash once to indicate locking has occurred.
If enabled through the DIC, the horn chirps when Q is pressed again within five seconds. See DIC Vehicle Customization on page 4???56 for additional information.
Pressing Q may arm the content theft???deterrent system. See Content
" (Unlock): Press once to unlock the driver door. If " is pressed again within five seconds, all remaining doors unlock. The interior lamps come on and stay on for
20 seconds or until the ignition is turned on. If enabled through the DIC, the parking lamps flash twice to indicate unlocking has occurred. See DIC Vehicle
Customization on page 4???56.
Pressing " on the RKE transmitter disarms the content theft???deterrent system. See Content
V (Remote Trunk Release): Press and hold for about one second to unlock the trunk. The transmission must be in P (Park).
L (Vehicle Locator/Panic Alarm): Press and release to locate the vehicle. The turn signal lamps flash and the horn sounds three times.
Press and hold L for more than two seconds to activate the panic alarm. The turn signal lamps flash and the horn sounds repeatedly for 30 seconds. The alarm turns off when the ignition is moved to ON/RUN
or L is pressed again. The ignition must be in LOCK/ OFF for the panic alarm to work.
The vehicle comes with two transmitters. Each transmitter will have a number on it, "1" or "2". These numbers correspond to the driver of the vehicle. For example, the memory seat position for driver 1 will be recalled when using the transmitter labeled "1",
if enabled through the DIC. See Memory Seat and Mirrors on page 2??? 7 and DIC Vehicle Customization on page 4???56 for more information.
Programming Transmitters to the Vehicle
Only RKE transmitters programmed to the vehicle will work. If a transmitter is lost or stolen, a replacement can be purchased and programmed through your dealer. When the replacement transmitter is programmed to the vehicle, all remaining transmitters must also be programmed. Any lost or stolen transmitters no longer work once the new transmitter is programmed. Each vehicle can have up to eight transmitters programmed to it. See your dealer for programming new transmitters.
Battery Replacement
Replace the battery if the REPLACE BATTERY IN REMOTE KEY message appears in the DIC. See ???REPLACE BATTERY IN REMOTE KEY??? under DIC Warnings and Messages on page 4???47 for additional information.
Notice: When replacing the battery, do not touch any of the circuitry on the transmitter. Static from your body could damage the transmitter.
To replace the battery:
1.Separate the transmitter with a flat, thin object, such as a flat head screwdriver.
.Carefully insert the tool into the notch located along the parting line of the transmitter. Do not insert the tool too far. Stop as soon as resistance is felt.
. Twist the tool until the transmitter is separated.
2.Remove the old battery. Do not use a metal object.
3.Insert the new battery, positive side facing down. Replace with a CR2032 or equivalent battery.
4.Snap the transmitter back together.
Remote Vehicle Start
Your vehicle may have a remote starting feature. This feature allows you to start the engine from outside the vehicle. It may also start the vehicle's heating or air conditioning systems, rear window defogger, and heated seats. See Heated Seats on page 2??? 5 and Heated and Ventilated Seats on page 2??? 6 for additional information. When the remote start system is active, the climate control system will heat or cool the inside of the vehicle at the setting the vehicle was set to when the vehicle was last turned off. The rear window defogger will be turned on by the climate control system when it is cold outside. If the vehicle has heated seats, they may also turn on when it is cold outside. Cooled
seats are not activated during a remote start. Normal operation of the system will return after the key is turned to the ON/RUN position.
Laws in some communities may restrict the use of remote starters. For example, some laws may require a person using the remote start to have the vehicle in view when doing so. Check local regulations for any requirements on remote starting of vehicles.
Do not use the remote start feature if your vehicle is low on fuel. Your vehicle may run out of fuel.
If your vehicle has the remote start feature, the RKE transmitter functions will have an increased range of operation. However, the range may be less while the vehicle is running.
There are other conditions which can affect the performance of the transmitter, see Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System on page 3??? 4 for additional information.
/ (Remote Start): This button will be on the RKE transmitter if you have remote start.
To start the vehicle using the remote start feature:
1.Aim the transmitter at the vehicle.
2.Press and release the transmitter's lock button, then immediately press and hold the transmitter's remote start button until the turn signal lights flash
or if the vehicle's lights are not visible, press and hold the remote start button for at least
four seconds.
When the vehicle starts, the parking lamps will turn on and remain on while the vehicle is running. The vehicle's doors will be locked.
3.If it is the first remote start since the vehicle has been driven, repeat these steps, while the engine is still running, to extend the engine running time by 10 minutes. Remote start can be extended one time.
After entering the vehicle during a remote start, insert and turn the key to ON/RUN to drive the vehicle.
If the vehicle is left running it will automatically shut off after 10 minutes unless a time extension has
been done.
To manually shut off a remote start:
.Aim the RKE transmitter at the vehicle and press the remote start button until the parking lamps turn off.
.Turn on the hazard warning flashers.
.Turn the ignition switch on and then off.
The vehicle can be started remotely two separate times between driving sequences. The engine will run for
10 minutes after each remote start.
Or, you can extend the engine run time by another 10 minutes within the first 10 minute remote start time frame, and before the engine stops.
For example, if the lock button and then the remote start buttons are pressed again after the vehicle has been running for five minutes, 10 minutes are added, allowing the engine to run for 15 minutes.
The additional 10 minutes are considered a second remote vehicle start.
Once two remote starts, or a single remote start with one time extension have been done, the vehicle must be started with the key.
After the key is removed from the ignition, another remote start can be performed.
The vehicle cannot be started remotely if the key is in the ignition, the hood is not closed, or if there is an emission control system malfunction.
Remote Start Ready
If your vehicle does not have the remote vehicle start feature, it may have the remote start ready feature. This feature allows your dealer to add the manufacturer's remote vehicle start feature.
See your dealer if you would like to add the manufacturer's remote vehicle start feature to your vehicle.
Doors and Locks
Door Locks
{ WARNING:
Unlocked doors can be dangerous.
.Passengers, especially children, can easily open the doors and fall out of a moving vehicle. When a door is locked, the handle will not open it. The chance of being thrown out of the vehicle in a crash is increased if the doors are not locked. So, all passengers should wear safety belts properly and the doors should be locked whenever the vehicle is driven.
.Young children who get into unlocked vehicles may be unable to get out. A child can be overcome by extreme heat and can suffer permanent injuries or even death from heat stroke. Always lock the vehicle whenever leaving it.
(Continued)
WARNING: (Continued)
.Outsiders can easily enter through an unlocked door when you slow down or stop your vehicle. Locking your doors can help prevent this from happening.
There are several ways to lock and unlock your vehicle.
From the outside, use either the key or the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter.
From the inside, use the power door lock switches or manual lock knobs. The manual lock knobs are located at the top of the door panel near the window.
Push the manual lock knob down to lock the door. To unlock the door, pull up on the knob.
Power Door Locks
With power door locks, the switches on the front doors can be used to lock and unlock the vehicle.
K (Unlock): Press to unlock the doors.
Q (Lock): Remove the key from the ignition and press to lock the doors.
Delayed Locking
This feature allows the driver to delay the actual locking of the doors. When the driver power door lock switch is pressed with the key removed from the ignition, and the driver door open, a chime will sound three times to signal that the delayed locking system is active. When all doors have been closed, the doors will lock automatically after several seconds. If any door is opened before this, the timer will reset itself once all the doors have been closed again.
Pressing the driver or passenger power door lock switch again or the RKE transmitter button will override this feature.
Personal Choice Programming
The delayed locking feature can be turned on or off, using the Driver Information Center (DIC) to program this feature. See ???DELAY DOOR LOCK??? under DIC Vehicle Customization on page 4???56.
Programmable Automatic Door
Locks
Your vehicle is programmed so that, when the doors are closed, the ignition is on, and the shift lever is moved out of P (Park), all the doors will lock. The doors will unlock every time you stop the vehicle and move the shift lever into P (Park).
If someone needs to get out while your vehicle is not in P (Park), have the person use the manual lock knob or power door lock switch. When the door is closed again, it will not lock automatically. Use the manual lock knob or power door lock switch to lock the door.
If your vehicle has a Driver Information Center (DIC), you can choose various lock and unlock settings. For programming information, see DIC Vehicle Customization on page 4???56.
Rear Door Security Locks
Rear door security locks prevent passengers from opening the rear doors from the inside.
The rear door security locks are located on the inside edge of each rear door. The rear doors must be opened to
access them.
To use the lock:
1.Insert the key into the security lock slot and turn it so the slot is in the horizontal position.
2.Close the door.
3.Do the same for the other rear door.
To open a rear door when the security lock is on, do the following:
1.Unlock the door using the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter, if the vehicle has one, the power door lock switch, or by lifting the rear door
manual lock.
2.Open the door from the outside.
To cancel the rear door security lock:
1.Unlock the door and open it from the outside.
2.Insert the key into the security lock slot and turn it so the slot is in the vertical position.
3.Do the same for the other rear door.
Lockout Protection
If the key is in the ignition and the power door lock switch is used to lock the doors, all doors will lock and then the driver door will unlock. It is always recommended that the ignition key is removed from the vehicle when locking the doors.
The lockout protection feature can be overridden by holding the power door lock switch for three seconds or longer.
Trunk
{ WARNING:
Exhaust gases can enter the vehicle if it is driven with the liftgate, trunk/hatch open, or with any objects that pass through the seal between the body and the trunk/hatch or liftgate. Engine exhaust contains Carbon Monoxide (CO) which cannot be seen or smelled. It can cause unconsciousness and even death.
If the vehicle must be driven with the liftgate, or trunk/hatch open:
.Close all of the windows.
.Fully open the air outlets on or under the instrument panel.
.Adjust the Climate Control system to a setting that brings in only outside air and set the fan speed to the highest setting. See Climate Control System in the Index.
.If the vehicle is equipped with a power liftgate, disable the power liftgate function.
For more information about carbon monoxide, see
Engine Exhaust on page 3???28.
The remote trunk release button Fis located on the instrument panel. See Instrument Panel on page 1???2.
Press the button to open the trunk. To use this feature, your vehicle must be in P (Park) or N (Neutral).
You can also press the remote trunk release button on the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter to open the trunk. See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation on page 3???4.
Notice: Do not use the emergency trunk release handle as a
There is a
Rear Seat Pass???Through
Your vehicle has a small door in the rear seat. This door allows you to access the trunk from inside the vehicle.
The rear seat armrest must be down for the
Windows
{ WARNING:
Leaving children, helpless adults, or pets in a vehicle with the windows closed is dangerous. They can be overcome by the extreme heat and suffer permanent injuries or even death from heat stroke. Never leave a child, a helpless adult, or a pet alone in a vehicle, especially with the windows closed in warm or hot weather.
The vehicle aerodynamics are designed to improve fuel economy performance. This may result in a pulsing sound when either rear window is down and the front windows are up. To reduce the sound, open either a front window or the sunroof (if equipped).
Power Windows
{ WARNING:
Leaving children in a vehicle with the keys is dangerous for many reasons. Children or others could be badly injured or even killed. They could operate the power windows or other controls or even make the vehicle move. The windows will function and they could be seriously injured or killed if caught in the path of a closing window. Do not leave keys in a vehicle with children.
When there are children in the rear seat use the window lockout button to prevent unintentional operation of the windows.
The power window switches are located on the driver's door armrest. In addition, each door has a switch for its own window.
Driver's Side shown
The front power window switches operate with one position for up and two positions for down movement and the rear power window switches operate with one position for up and one for down movement.
Your vehicle has Retained Accessory Power (RAP) that allows you to use the power windows once the ignition has been turned off. For more information, see Retained Accessory Power (RAP) on page 3???19.
This feature is on the front windows. Press the switch to the second position to activate the
Window Lockout
o (Window Lockout): The rear window lockout button is located on the driver's door armrest near the window switches.
Press the right side of this button to disable the rear window controls. The light on the button will come on, indicating the feature is in use. The rear windows still can be raised or lowered using the driver's window switches when the lockout feature is active.
To restore power to the rear windows, press the button again. The light on the button will go out.
Sun Visors
Pull the visor toward you, or move to the side to help reduce glare.
On vehicles with a lighted vanity mirror, lift the attached cover to use.
This vehicle has
Content
Your vehicle may have the optional content
To activate the
1.Open the door.
2.Lock the door with the power door lock switch or the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter. If you are using the RKE transmitter, the door does not need to be open.
3.Close all doors.
Once armed, the alarm will go off if someone tries to enter the vehicle without using the RKE transmitter or a key or turns the ignition on with an incorrect key. The horn will sound and the turn signal lamps will flash for about 30 seconds.
When the alarm is armed, the trunk may be opened with the RKE transmitter. The power door lock switches are disabled and the doors remain locked. You must use your RKE transmitter or your key to unlock the doors when the system is armed.
Arming with the Power Lock Switch
The alarm system will arm when you use either power lock switch to lock the doors while any door is open and the key is removed from the ignition. The alarm system will not arm if the truck is open when you use either power lock switch to lock the doors.
Arming with the RKE Transmitter
The alarm system will arm when you use your RKE transmitter to lock the doors, if the key is not in the ignition.
Disarming with the RKE Transmitter
The alarm system will disarm when you use your RKE transmitter to unlock the doors.
The first time a remote unlock command is received, three flashes will be seen and three horn chirps heard to indicate an alarm condition has occurred since last arming.
Disarming with Your Key
The alarm system will disarm when you use your key to unlock the doors or insert your key in the ignition and turn it from the LOCK/OFF position.
Immobilizer
See Radio Frequency Statement on page 8???17 for information regarding Part 15 of the Federal Communications Commission (FCC) rules and Industry Canada Standards
Immobilizer Operation
Your vehicle is equipped with
The system is automatically armed when the key is removed from the ignition.
You do not have to manually arm or disarm the system.
The security light will come on if there is a problem with arming or disarming the
When the
When trying to start the vehicle if the engine does not start and the security light on the instrument panel cluster comes on, there may be a problem with your
If the engine still does not start, and the key appears to be not damaged, try another ignition key. At this time, you may also want to check the fuse, see Fuses and Circuit Breakers on page 6???106. If the engine still does not start with the other key, your vehicle needs service. If your vehicle does start, the first key may be faulty. See your dealer who can service the
It is possible for the
See your dealer or a locksmith who can service
To program the new key:
1.Verify that the new key has a 1 stamped on it.
2.Insert the already programmed key in the ignition and start the engine. If the engine will not start, see your dealer for service.
3.After the engine has started, turn the key to LOCK/ OFF, and remove the key.
4.Insert the key to be programmed and turn it to the ON/RUN position within five seconds of the original key being turned to the LOCK/OFF position.
The security light will turn off once the key has been programmed.
5.Repeat Steps 1 through 4 if additional keys are to be programmed.
If you lose or damage your
Do not leave the key or device that disarms or deactivates the theft deterrent system in the vehicle.
Starting and Operating Your
Vehicle
New Vehicle
Notice: The vehicle does not need an elaborate
.Do not drive at any one constant speed, fast or slow, for the first 500 miles (805 km). Do not make
.Avoid making hard stops for the first
200 miles (322 km) or so. During this time the new brake linings are not yet broken in. Hard stops with new linings can mean premature wear and earlier replacement. Follow this
.Do not tow a trailer during
Towing a Trailer on page 5???25 for the trailer towing capabilities of your vehicle and more information.
Following break???in, engine speed and load can be gradually increased.
Ignition Positions
The ignition has four different positions:
In order to shift out of P (Park), ignition must be in the ON/RUN and the regular brake pedal must be applied.
Notice: Using a tool to force the key to turn in the ignition could cause damage to the switch or break the key. Use the correct key, make sure it is all the way in, and turn it only with your hand. If the key cannot be turned by hand, see your dealer.
A (STOPPING THE ENGINE/LOCK/OFF): When the vehicle is stopped, turn the ignition switch to LOCK/OFF to turn the engine off. Retained Accessory Power (RAP) will remain active. See Retained Accessory Power (RAP) on page 3???19.
This position locks the ignition. It also locks the transmission and steering column. This is the only position in which the ignition key can be inserted or removed.
Do not turn the engine off when the vehicle is moving. This will cause a loss of power assist in the brake and steering systems and disable the airbags.
In an emergency:
1.Brake using a firm and steady pressure. Do not pump the brakes repeatedly. This may deplete power assist, requiring increased brake pedal force.
2.Shift the vehicle to N (Neutral). This can be done while the vehicle is moving. After shifting to N (Neutral), firmly apply the brakes and steer the vehicle to a safe location.
3.Come to a complete stop, shift to P (Park), and turn the ignition to LOCK/OFF. On vehicles with an automatic transmission, the shift lever must be in P (Park) to turn the ignition switch to the LOCK/ OFF position.
4.Set the parking brake. See Parking Brake on page 3???24.
The steering can bind with the wheels turned off center. If this happens, move the steering wheel from right to left while turning the key to ACC/ACCESSORY. If this doesn't work, then the vehicle needs service.
B (ACC/ACCESSORY): This position lets the radio and windshield wipers operate while the engine is off. To use ACC/ACCESSORY, turn the key clockwise.
C (ON/RUN): This position can be used to operate electrical accessories and to display some of the warning and indicator lights. The switch stays in this position when the engine is running.
If you leave the key in the ACC/ACCESSORY or ON/ RUN position with the engine off, the battery could be drained. You may not be able to start the vehicle if the battery is allowed to drain for an extended period
of time.
D (START): This position starts the engine. When the engine starts, release the key. The ignition switch returns to ON/RUN for driving.
A warning tone will sound and the Driver Information Center (DIC) will display DRIVER DOOR OPEN when the driver door is opened if the ignition is in LOCK/OFF, ACC/ACCESSORY and the key is in the ignition. See
DIC Warnings and Messages on page 4???47 for more
information.
Retained Accessory Power (RAP)
The following accessories can be used for up to 10 minutes after the engine is turned off.
.Audio System
.Audio Steering Wheel (if equipped)
.Clock
.Power Windows
.Sunroof (if equipped)
Power to these accessories works up to 10 minutes or until the driver door is opened.
The instrument panel cluster lights stay on for a few seconds, then will go out. Once the driver door is opened, the power shuts off to these accessories. The vehicle has a feature designed to protect the battery against drainage. For more information see Inadvertent Power Battery Saver on page 4???14 and Electric Power Management on page 4???13.
Starting the Engine
Move the shift lever to P (Park) or N (Neutral). The engine will not start in any other position. To restart the engine when the vehicle is already moving, use
N (Neutral) only.
Notice: Do not try to shift to P (Park) if the vehicle is moving. If you do, you could damage the transmission. Shift to P (Park) only when the vehicle is stopped.
Starting Procedure
1.With your foot off the accelerator pedal, turn the ignition to START. When the engine starts, let go of the key. The idle speed will slow down as the
engine warms. Do not race the engine immediately after starting it. Operate the engine and transmission gently to allow the oil to warm up and lubricate all moving parts.
The vehicle has a
Notice: Cranking the engine for long periods of time, by returning the key to the START position immediately after cranking has ended, can overheat and damage the cranking motor, and drain the battery. Wait at least 15 seconds between each try, to let the cranking motor cool down.
2.If the engine does not start after 5???10 seconds, especially in very cold weather (below 0??F or ???18??C), it could be flooded with too much gasoline. Try pushing the accelerator pedal all the way to the floor and holding it there as you hold the key in
START for up to a maximum of 15 seconds. Wait at least 15 seconds between each try, to allow the cranking motor to cool down. When the engine starts, let go of the key and accelerator. If the vehicle starts briefly but then stops again, repeat these steps. This clears the extra gasoline from the engine. Do not race the engine immediately after starting it. Operate the engine and transmission gently until the oil warms up and lubricates all moving parts.
Notice: The engine is designed to work with the electronics in the vehicle. If you add electrical parts or accessories, you could change the way the engine operates. Before adding electrical equipment, check with your dealer. If you do not, the engine might not perform properly. Any resulting damage would not be covered by the vehicle warranty.
Engine Coolant Heater
The engine coolant heater can provide easier starting and better fuel economy during engine warm???up in cold weather conditions at or below 0??F (???18??C). Vehicles with an engine coolant heater should be plugged in at least four hours before starting.
To Use the Engine Coolant Heater
1.Turn off the engine.
2.Open the hood and unwrap the electrical cord.
On vehicles with the 3.9L V6 engine, the coolant heater cord is located on the driver side of the vehicle, near the strut tower. On vehicles with the 4.6L V8 engine, the cord is located on the driver side of the vehicle on the right side of the engine air cleaner. It is between the engine cover and the engine air cleaner.
{WARNING:
Plugging the cord into an ungrounded outlet could cause an electrical shock. Also, the wrong kind of extension cord could overheat and cause a fire.
You could be seriously injured. Plug the cord into a properly grounded
15amps.
3.Plug the cord into a normal, grounded
4.Before starting the engine, be sure to unplug and store the cord as it was before to keep it away from moving engine parts, and prevent damage.
The length of time the heater should remain plugged in depends on several factors. Ask a dealer in the area where you will be parking the vehicle for the best advice on this.
Automatic Transmission Operation
The vehicle may have a shift lever located either on the steering column or on the console between the seats.
P (Park): This position locks the front wheels. It is the best position to use when you start the engine because the vehicle cannot move easily.
{ WARNING:
It is dangerous to get out of the vehicle if the shift lever is not fully in P (Park) with the parking brake firmly set. The vehicle can roll.
Do not leave the vehicle when the engine is running unless you have to. If you have left the engine running, the vehicle can move suddenly. You or others could be injured. To be sure the vehicle will not move, even when you are on fairly level ground, always set the parking brake and move the shift lever to P (Park). See Shifting Into Park on page 3???25. If you are pulling a trailer, see Towing a Trailer on page 5???25.
Make sure the shift lever is fully in P (Park) before starting the engine. The vehicle has an automatic transmission shift lock control system. You have to fully apply the regular brakes before you can shift from
P (Park) while the ignition is in ON/RUN. If you cannot shift out of P (Park), ease pressure on the shift lever and push the shift lever all the way into P (Park) as you maintain brake application. Then move the shift lever into the gear you want. See Shifting Out of Park on page 3???26.
R (Reverse): Use this gear to back up.
Notice: Shifting to R (Reverse) while the vehicle is moving forward could damage the transmission. The repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Shift to R (Reverse) only after the vehicle is stopped.
To rock the vehicle back and forth to get out of snow, ice, or sand without damaging the transmission, see If
Your Vehicle is Stuck in Sand, Mud, Ice, or Snow on page 5???17.
N (Neutral): In this position, the engine does not connect with the wheels. To restart the engine when the vehicle is already moving, use N (Neutral) only. Also, use N (Neutral) when the vehicle is being towed.
{ WARNING:
Shifting into a drive gear while the engine is running at high speed is dangerous. Unless your foot is firmly on the brake pedal, the vehicle could move very rapidly. You could lose control and hit people or objects. Do not shift into a drive gear while the engine is running at high speed.
Notice: Shifting out of P (Park) or N (Neutral) with the engine running at high speed may damage the transmission. The repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Be sure the engine is not running at high speed when shifting the vehicle.
D (Drive): This position is for normal driving. It provides the best fuel economy. If you need more power for passing, and you are:
.Going less than about 35 mph (55 km/h), push the accelerator pedal about halfway down.
.Going about 35 mph (55 km/h) or more, push the accelerator all the way down.
The transmission will shift down to the next gear and have more power.
Downshifting the transmission in slippery road conditions could result in skidding, see ???Skidding??? under
Loss of Control on page 5???10
3 (Third): This position is also used for normal driving. It reduces vehicle speed more than D (Drive) without using the brakes. You might choose 3 (Third) instead of D (Drive) when driving on hilly, winding roads, when towing a trailer, so there is less shifting between gears and when going down a steep hill.
2 (Second): This position reduces vehicle speed even more than 3 (Third) without using the brakes. You can use 2 (Second) on hills. It can help control vehicle speed as you go down steep mountain roads, but then you would also want to use the brakes off and on.
Notice: Driving in 2 (Second) for more than 25 miles (40 km) or at speeds over 55 mph (90 km/h) may damage the transmission. Also, shifting into
2 (Second) at speeds above 65 mph (105 km/h) can cause damage. Drive in 3 (Third) or D (Drive) instead of 2 (Second).
1 (First): This position reduces vehicle speed even more than 2 (Second) without using the brakes. You can use it on very steep hills, or in deep snow or mud. If the shift lever is put in 1 (First) while going forward, the transmission will not shift into first gear until the vehicle is going slowly enough.
Notice: Spinning the tires or holding the vehicle in one place on a hill using only the accelerator pedal may damage the transmission. The repair will not be covered by the vehicle warranty. If you are stuck, do not spin the tires. When stopping on a hill, use the brakes to hold the vehicle in place.
Parking Brake
The parking brake pedal is located to the left of the regular brake pedal, near the driver door.
To set the parking brake, hold the regular brake pedal down, then push the parking brake pedal down.
If the ignition is on, the brake system warning light on the instrument panel cluster should come on. If it does not, you need to have the vehicle serviced.
A warning chime will sound if the parking brake is set, the ignition is on, and the vehicle speed is greater than 5 mph (8 km/h). The brake light will come on and stay on until the parking brake is released. See Brake System Warning Light on page 4???31 for more information.
To release the parking brake, hold the regular brake pedal down, then push the parking brake pedal down. When you lift your foot off the parking brake pedal, the pedal will follow your foot to the released position.
Notice: Driving with the parking brake on can overheat the brake system and cause premature wear or damage to brake system parts. Make sure that the parking brake is fully released and the brake warning light is off before driving.
If you are towing a trailer and are parking on any hill, see Towing a Trailer on page 5???25.
Shifting Into Park
{ WARNING:
It can be dangerous to get out of the vehicle if the shift lever is not fully in P (Park) with the parking brake firmly set. The vehicle can roll. If you have left the engine running, the vehicle can move suddenly. You or others could be injured. To be sure the vehicle will not move, even when you are on fairly level ground, use the steps that follow.
If you are pulling a trailer, see Towing a Trailer on page 5???25.
Steering Column Shift Lever
If the vehicle has a steering column shift lever, use this procedure to shift the vehicle into P (Park):
1.Hold the brake pedal down.
2.Move the shift lever into P (Park) by pulling the shift lever toward you and moving it up as far as it will go.
3.With your foot still holding the brake pedal down, set the parking brake. See Parking Brake on page 3???24 for more information.
4.Turn the ignition key to LOCK/OFF.
5.Remove the key and take it with you. If you can leave the vehicle with the ignition key in your hand, the vehicle is in P (Park).
Console Shift Lever
If the vehicle is equipped with a console shift lever, use this procedure to shift the vehicle into P (Park):
1.Hold the brake pedal down.
2.Move the shift lever into P (Park) by pushing the lever all the way toward the front of the vehicle and then to the left.
3.While keeping the brake pedal applied, set the parking brake. See Parking Brake on page 3???24 for more information.
4.Turn the ignition key to LOCK/OFF.
5.Remove the key and take it with you. If you can leave the vehicle with the ignition key in your hand, the vehicle is in P (Park).
Leaving the Vehicle With the Engine
Running
{ WARNING:
It can be dangerous to leave the vehicle with the engine running. The vehicle could move suddenly if the shift lever is not fully in P (Park) with the parking brake firmly set. And, if you leave the vehicle with the engine running, it could overheat and even catch fire. You or others could be injured. Do not leave the vehicle with the engine running.
If you have to leave the vehicle with the engine running, be sure your vehicle is in P (Park) and the parking brake is firmly set before you leave it. See Parking Brake on page 3???24 for more information.
Torque Lock
Torque lock is when the weight of the vehicle puts too much force on the parking pawl in the transmission. This happens when parking on a hill and shifting the transmission into P (Park) is not done properly and then it is difficult to shift out of P (Park). To prevent torque lock, set the parking brake and then shift into P (Park). To find out how, see ???Shifting Into Park??? in this section.
If torque lock does occur, your vehicle may need to be pushed uphill by another vehicle to relieve the parking pawl pressure, so you can shift out of P (Park).
Shifting Out of Park
Automatic Transmission Shift Lock
This vehicle has an electronic shift lock release system. The shift lock release is designed to:
.Prevent ignition key removal unless the shift lever is in P (Park)
.Prevent movement of the shift lever out of P (Park), unless the ignition is in ON/RUN and the regular brake pedal is applied.
The shift lock is always functional except in the case of a an uncharged or low voltage (less than 9 volt) battery.
If the vehicle has an uncharged battery or a battery with low voltage, try charging or jump starting the battery. See Jump Starting on page 6???44.
Console Shift
If the console shifter cannot be moved out of P (Park)
1.Apply and maintain the regular brakes.
2.Turn the ignition to ON/RUN position. See Ignition Positions on page 3???18 for more information.
3.Let up on the shift lever and make sure the shift lever is pushed all the way into P (Park).
4.Then, move the shift into the desired gear.
If you still cannot move the shift lever from P (Park), consult your dealer or a professional towing service.
Column Shift
If the shifter cannot be moved out of P (Park)
1.Apply and maintain the regular brakes.
2.Turn the ignition key to the ON/RUN position. See Ignition Positions on page 3???18 for more information.
3.Shift out of the P (Park) position to the N (Neutral) position.
4.Then, move the shift into the desired gear.
If you still cannot move the shift lever from P (Park), consult your dealer or a professional towing service.
Parking Over Things That Burn
{ WARNING:
Things that can burn could touch hot exhaust parts under the vehicle and ignite. Do not park over papers, leaves, dry grass, or other things that can burn.
Engine Exhaust
{ WARNING:
Engine exhaust contains Carbon Monoxide (CO) which cannot be seen or smelled. Exposure to CO can cause unconsciousness and even death.
Exhaust may enter the vehicle if:
.The vehicle idles in areas with poor ventilation (parking garages, tunnels, deep snow that may block underbody airflow or tail pipes).
.The exhaust smells or sounds strange or different.
.The exhaust system leaks due to corrosion or damage.
.The vehicle???s exhaust system has been modified, damaged or improperly repaired.
.There are holes or openings in the vehicle body from damage or
(Continued)
WARNING: (Continued)
If unusual fumes are detected or if it is suspected that exhaust is coming into the vehicle:
.Drive it only with the windows completely down.
.Have the vehicle repaired immediately.
Never park the vehicle with the engine running in an enclosed area such as a garage or a building that has no fresh air ventilation.
Running the Vehicle While Parked
It is better not to park with the engine running. But if you ever have to, here are some things to know.
{ WARNING:
Idling a vehicle in an enclosed area with poor ventilation is dangerous. Engine exhaust may enter the vehicle. Engine exhaust contains Carbon Monoxide (CO) which cannot be seen or smelled. It can cause unconsciousness and even
(Continued)
WARNING: (Continued)
death. Never run the engine in an enclosed area that has no fresh air ventilation. For more information, see Engine Exhaust on page 3???28.
{ WARNING:
It can be dangerous to get out of the vehicle if the automatic transmission shift lever is not fully in
P (Park) with the parking brake firmly set. The vehicle can roll. Do not leave the vehicle when the engine is running unless you have to. If you have left the engine running, the vehicle can move suddenly. You or others could be injured. To be sure the vehicle will not move, even when you are on fairly level ground, always set the parking brake and move the shift lever to P (Park).
Follow the proper steps to be sure the vehicle will not move. See Shifting Into Park on page 3???25.
If parking on a hill and pulling a trailer, see Towing a Trailer on page 5???25.
Mirrors
Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror
The vehicle may have an automatic dimming inside rearview mirror with OnStar?? and/or a compass display. Automatic dimming reduces the glare from the headlamps of the vehicle behind you. The dimming feature comes on and the indicator light illuminates each time the vehicle is started.
Vehicles with OnStar have three additional control buttons located at the bottom of the mirror. See your dealer for more information on the system and how to subscribe to OnStar. See the OnStar?? owners guide for more information about the services OnStar provides.
O(On/Off): Press to turn the dimming feature and/or compass display on or off.
Cleaning the Mirror
Do not spray glass cleaner directly on the mirror. Use a soft towel dampened with water.
Compass
Compass Operation
There is a compass display in the upper right corner of the mirror.
Compass Calibration
Press and hold Oto activate the compass calibration mode. CAL displays in the compass window on the mirror.
If after a few seconds the display does not show a compass direction, (N for North for example), there may be a strong magnetic field interfering with the compass. Interference can be caused by a magnetic antenna mount, note pad holder, or similar object. If CAL displays in the compass window, the compass may need to be reset or calibrated.
The compass can be calibrated by driving the vehicle in circles at 5 mph (8 km/h) or less until the display reads a direction.
Compass Variance
The compass is set to zone eight. If you do not live in zone eight or drive out of the area, the compass variance needs to be changed to the appropriate zone.
To adjust for compass variance:
1.Find your current location and variance zone number on the following zone map.
2.Press and hold Ountil the zone number displays. The number shown is the current zone number.
3.Once the zone number displays, press O repeatedly until the correct zone number displays. Stop pressing the button and the mirror returns to normal operation. If CAL appears in the compass window, the compass may need calibration. See ???Compass Calibration??? listed previously.
Outside Power Mirrors
Controls for the outside power mirrors are located on the driver's door armrest.
To adjust the mirror:
1.Press the left or right side of the selector switch located beneath the control pad to choose the driver or passenger side mirror.
2.Press one of the four arrows located on the control pad to move the mirror in the desired direction.
3.Adjust each outside mirror so that a little of the vehicle and the area behind it can be seen.
Manually fold the mirrors inward to prevent damage when going through an automatic car wash. To fold, push the mirror toward the vehicle. Push the mirror outward, to return to its original position.
Outside Automatic Dimming Mirror
If the vehicle has this feature, the driver side mirror adjusts for the glare of headlamps behind you. This feature is controlled by the on and off settings on the automatic dimming rearview mirror. See Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror on page 3???29 for more information.
Turn Signal Indicator
The vehicle may also have a turn signal indicator on the mirror. An arrow on the outside rearview mirror flashes in the direction of the turn or lane change. See Turn and
Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA)
If the vehicle has the Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) system, see Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) on page 3???34.
Park Tilt Mirrors
If the vehicle has memory mirrors, the outside mirrors have park tilt mirrors . This feature tilts the driver's side and passenger side mirror to a factory programmed position when the vehicle is in R (Reverse). This feature may be useful in allowing you to view the curb when you are parallel parking.
When the vehicle is shifted out of R (Reverse) and either a five second delay has occurred, or the ignition is turned to LOCK/OFF, the driver and passenger side mirrors return to their original position.
See DIC Vehicle Customization on page 4???56 for more information.
Outside Convex Mirror
{ WARNING:
A convex mirror can make things, like other vehicles, look farther away than they really are.
If you cut too sharply into the right lane, you could hit a vehicle on the right. Check the inside mirror or glance over your shoulder before changing lanes.
The passenger side mirror is convex shaped. A convex mirror's surface is curved so more can be seen from the driver seat.
Outside Heated Mirrors
For vehicles with heated mirrors:
< (Rear Window Defogger): Press to heat the mirrors.
See ???Rear Window Defogger??? under Climate Control System on page 4???16 or Dual Automatic Climate Control System on page 4???19 for more information.
Object Detection Systems
Ultrasonic Rear Parking
Assist (URPA)
For vehicles with the Ultrasonic Rear Parking Assist (URPA) system, it operates at speeds less than 8 km/h (5 mph), and assists the driver with parking and avoiding objects while in R (Reverse). The sensors on the rear bumper are used to detect the distance to an object up to 2.5 m (8 ft) behind the vehicle, and at least 25 cm (10 in) off the ground.
{ WARNING:
The Ultrasonic Rear Parking Assist (URPA) system does not replace driver vision. It cannot detect:
.Objects that are below the bumper, underneath the vehicle, or too close or far from the vehicle
.Children, pedestrians, bicyclists, or pets.
(Continued)
WARNING: (Continued)
If you do not use proper care before and while backing, vehicle damage, injury, or death could occur. Even with URPA, always check behind the vehicle before backing up. While backing, be sure to look for objects and check the vehicle's mirrors.
How the System Works
URPA comes on automatically when the shift lever is moved into R (Reverse). A single tone sounds to indicate the system is working.
URPA operates only at speeds less than 8 km/h (5 mph).
An obstacle is indicated by audible beeps. The interval between the beeps becomes shorter as the vehicle gets closer to the obstacle. When the distance is less than 30 cm (12 in) the beeps are continuous.
To be detected, objects must be at least 25 cm (10 in) off the ground and below trunk level. Objects must also be within 2.5 m (8 ft) from the rear bumper. This distance may be less during warmer or humid weather.
The system can be disabled through the Driver Information Center (DIC). See ???Park Assist??? under DIC Operation and Displays on page 4???41 for more information.
When the System Does Not Seem to Work Properly
SERVICE PARK ASSIST: If this message occurs, take the vehicle to your dealer to repair the system.
PARK ASSIST OFF: If the URPA system does not activate due to a temporary condition, the message displays on the DIC, see DIC Operation and Displays on page 4???41 for more information. This can occur under the following conditions:
.The driver disables the system.
.The ultrasonic sensors are not clean. Keep the vehicle's rear bumper free of mud, dirt, snow, ice and slush. For cleaning instructions, see Washing Your Vehicle on page 6???100.
.A trailer was attached to the vehicle, or a bicycle or an object was hanging out of the trunk during the last drive cycle. Once the object is removed, URPA will return to normal operation.
.A tow bar is attached to the vehicle.
.The vehicle's bumper is damaged. Take the vehicle to your dealer to repair the system.
.Other conditions may affect system performance, such as vibrations from a jackhammer or the compression of air brakes on a very large truck.
If the system is still disabled, after driving forward at least 40 km/h (25 mph), take the vehicle to your dealer.
Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA)
The vehicle may have a Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) system. Read this entire section before using the system.
{ WARNING:
SBZA is only a lane changing aid and does not replace driver vision. SBZA does not detect:
.Vehicles outside the side blind zones which may be rapidly approaching.
.Pedestrians, bicyclists, or animals.
Failure to use proper care when changing lanes may result in damage to the vehicle, injury,
or death. Always check the outside and rearview mirrors, glance over your shoulder, and use the turn signal before changing lanes.
When the system detects a vehicle in the side blind zone, amber SBZA displays will light up in the side mirrors. This indicates that it may be unsafe to change lanes. Before making a lane change, always check the SBZA display, check the outside and rearview mirrors, look over your shoulder for vehicles and hazards, and use the turn signal.
SBZA Detection Zones
The SBZA sensor covers a zone of approximately one lane over from both sides of the vehicle, 3.5 m (11 ft). This zone starts at each side mirror and goes back approximately 5 m (16 ft). The height of the zone is approximately between 0.5 m (1.5 ft) and 2.0 m (6 ft) off the ground.
The SBZA detection zones do not change if the vehicle is towing a trailer. So be extra careful when changing lanes while towing a trailer.
How the System Works
Left Side Mirror Display Right Side Mirror Display
When the vehicle is started, both outside mirror displays will briefly come on to indicate that the system is operating. While driving forward, the left or right side mirror SBZA display will light up if a vehicle is detected in that blind zone. If you activate a turn signal and a
vehicle has been detected on the same side, the SBZA display will flash to give you extra warning not to change lanes.
SBZA displays do not come on while the vehicle is approaching or passing other vehicles. At speeds greater then 20 mph (32 km/h), SBZA displays may come on when a vehicle you have passed remains in or drops back into the detection zone.
SBZA can be disabled through the Driver Information Center (DIC). See Driver Information Center (DIC) on page 4???40 for more information. If the SBZA is disabled by the driver, the SBZA mirror displays will not light up during normal driving.
When the System Does Not Seem To Work
Properly
Occasional missed alerts can occur under normal circumstances and will increase in wet conditions. The system does not need to be serviced due to an occasional missed alert. The number of missed alerts will increase with increased rainfall or road spray.
If the SBZA displays do not light up when the system is on and vehicles are in the blind zone, the system may need service. Take the vehicle to your dealer.
SBZA is designed to ignore stationary objects; however, the system may occasionally light up due to guard rails, signs, trees, shrubs, and other stationary objects. This is normal system operation, the vehicle does not need service.
SBZA does not operate when the left or right corners of the rear bumper are covered with mud, dirt, snow, ice, slush, or in heavy rainstorms. For cleaning instructions, see Washing Your Vehicle on page 6???100. If the DIC still displays the SIDE BLIND ZONE SYS. UNAVAILABLE message after cleaning the bumper, see your dealer.
The SBZA displays may remain on if a trailer is attached to the vehicle, or a bicycle or object is extending out to either side of the vehicle.
When SBZA is disabled for any reason other than the driver turning it off, the driver will not be able to turn SBZA back on using the DIC. The SIDE BLIND ZONE ALERT ON option will not be selectable if the conditions for normal system operation are not met. Until normal operating conditions for SBZA are met, you should not rely upon SBZA while driving.
SBZA Error Messages
The following messages may appear in the DIC:
SIDE BLIND ZONE ALERT SYSTEM OFF: This message indicates that the driver has turned the system off.
SIDE BLIND ZONE SYS. UNAVAILABLE: This message indicates that the SBZA system is disabled because the sensor is blocked and cannot detect vehicles in the blind zone. The sensor may be blocked by mud, dirt, snow, ice, slush, or even heavy rainstorms. This message may also activate during heavy rain or due to road spray. The vehicle does not need service. For cleaning, see Washing Your Vehicle on page 6???100.
SERVICE SIDE BLIND ZONE ALERT SYSTEM: If this message appears, both SBZA displays will remain on indicating there is a problem with the SBZA system.
If these displays remain on after continued driving, the system needs service. Take the vehicle to your dealer.
FCC Information
See Radio Frequency Statement on page 8???17 for information regarding Part 15 of the Federal Communications Commission (FCC) rules and Industry Canada Standards
Frequency of operation: 24.05GHz ??? 24.25GHz
Field Strength: Not greater than 2.5V/m peak (0.25V/m average) at a distance of 3 m.
The manufacturer is not responsible for any radio or TV interference caused by unauthorized modifications to this equipment. Such modifications could void the user's authority to operate the equipment.
Lane Departure Warning (LDW)
The vehicle may have a Lane Departure Warning (LDW) system. Read this entire section before using the system.
{ WARNING:
The Lane Departure Warning (LDW) system does not steer the vehicle and is only an aid to help you stay in your driving lane. The LDW system
may not:
.Provide you with enough time to avoid a lane change collision.
.Be loud enough for you to hear the warning beeps.
.Work properly under bad weather conditions or if the windshield is not kept clean.
.Detect lane markings and will not detect road edges.
.Warn you that your vehicle is crossing a lane marking if the system does not detect the lane marking.
(Continued)
WARNING: (Continued)
LDW will indicate the system is working whenever it detects either the left or right lane marking. So if you depart on the side of the lane that LDW is not detecting, LDW will not warn you.
If you do not carefully maintain your vehicle position within the lane, vehicle damage, injury, or death could occur. Even with LDW, always keep your attention on the road and maintain proper vehicle position within the lane. Always keep the windshield clean and do not use LDW in bad weather conditions.
When the vehicle crosses a detected lane marking, the LDW symbol will flash and you will hear three beeps. LDW will not warn you if the turn signal is on or if you make a sharp maneuver. Before making a lane change, check the vehicle's mirrors, glance over your shoulder for vehicles and hazards, and start the turn signal before changing lanes.
How the System Works
LDW uses a camera located between the inside rearview mirror and the windshield to detect the lane markings.
@ (Lane Departure Warning): To turn LDW on and off, press the LDW control, located by the exterior headlamp control. An indicator on the control will light to indicate that LDW is on.
When the vehicle is started, the LDW symbol, located in the instrument panel cluster, will briefly come on to indicate that the light is operational.
LDW only operates at speeds of 35 mph (56 km) or greater. If LDW is turned on when traveling at these speeds, the LDW symbol will appear green if the system detects a left or right lane marking. This symbol
will change to amber and flash and three beeps will sound if you cross a detected lane marking without using the turn signal.
If the LDW symbol does not appear, LDW is not currently operating and will not warn you.
To change the volume of the warning chime, see Chime Volume under DIC Vehicle Customization on page 4???56 for more information.
When the System Does Not Seem To Work
Properly
The LDW symbol will not appear when the system is having difficulty seeing the lines on the road or if the view of the camera on the windshield is blocked with mud, dirt, snow, ice, or slush, if the windshield is damaged, or when weather limits visibility, such as while driving in fog, rain, or snow conditions. This is normal operation, the vehicle does not need service. For cleaning instructions, see Washing Your Vehicle on page 6???100.
LDW warnings may occasionally occur due to tar marks, shadows, cracks in the road, or other road imperfections. This is normal system operation, the vehicle does not need service.
LDW Error Message
SERVICE LANE DEPARTURE SYSTEM: This message may appear in the DIC to indicate that LDW is not working properly. If this message remains on after continued driving, the system needs service. Take your vehicle to your dealer.
LANE DEPARTURE SYSTEM UNAVAILABLE : This message may appear in the DIC if LDW does not activate due to a temporary condition.
Universal Home Remote
System
See Radio Frequency Statement on page 8???17 for information regarding Part 15 of the Federal Communications Commission (FCC) rules and Industry Canada Standards
Universal Home Remote System
Operation (With Three Round LED)
This vehicle may have the Universal Home Remote System. If there are three round Light Emitting Diode (LED) indicator lights above the Universal Home Remote buttons, follow the instructions below.
This system provides a way to replace up to three remote control transmitters used to activate devices such as garage door openers, security systems, and home automation devices.
Do not use this system with any garage door opener that does not have the stop and reverse feature. This includes any garage door opener model manufactured before April 1, 1982.
Read the instructions completely before attempting to program the transmitter. Because of the steps involved, it may be helpful to have another person assist with programming the transmitter.
Be sure to keep the original remote control transmitter for use in other vehicles, as well as, for future programming. Only the original remote control transmitter is needed for Fixed Code programming. The programmed buttons should be erased when the vehicle is sold or the lease ends. See ???Erasing Universal Home Remote Buttons??? later in this section.
Park the vehicle outside of the garage when programming a garage door. Be sure that people and objects are clear of the garage door or gate that is being programmed.
Programming Universal Home
Remote ??? Rolling Code
For questions or help programming the Universal Home Remote System, call
Most garage door openers sold after 1996 are Rolling Code units.
Programming a garage door opener involves
To program up to three devices:
1.From inside the vehicle, press the two outside buttons at the same time for one to two seconds, and immediately release them.
2.Locate in the garage, the garage door opener receiver
30 seconds.
3.Immediately return to the vehicle. Press and hold the Universal Home Remote button that will be used to control the garage door until the garage door moves. The indicator light, above the selected button, should slowly blink. This button may need to be held for up to 20 seconds.
4.Immediately, within one second, release the button when the garage door moves. The indicator light will blink rapidly until programming is complete.
5.Press and release the same button again. The garage door should move, confirming that programming is successful and complete.
To program another Rolling Code device such as an additional garage door opener, a security device,
or home automation device, repeat Steps 1 through 5, choosing a different function button in Step 3 than what was used for the garage door opener.
If these instructions do not work, the garage door opener is probably a Fixed Code unit. Follow the Programming instructions that follow for a Fixed Code garage door opener.
Programming Universal Home
Remote ??? Fixed Code
For questions or help programming the Universal Home Remote System, call
Most garage door openers sold before 1996 are Fixed Code units.
Programming a garage door opener involves
To program up to three devices:
1.To verify that the garage door opener is a Fixed Code unit, remove the battery cover on the hand held transmitter supplied by the manufacturer of the garage door opener motor. If there are a row of dip switches similar to the graphic above, the garage door opener is a Fixed Code unit. If you do not see a row of dip switches, return to the previous section for Programming Universal Home Remote ??? Rolling Code.
Your hand held transmitter can have between eight to 12 dip switches depending on the brand of transmitter.
The garage door opener receiver (motor head unit) could also have a row of dip switches that can be used when programming the Universal Home Remote. If the total number of switches on the motor head and hand held transmitter are different, or if the dip switch settings are different, use the dip switch settings on the motor head unit to program the Universal Home Remote. The motor head dip switch settings can also be used when the original hand held transmitter is not available.
Example of Eight Dip Switches with Three Positions
The panel of switches might not appear exactly as they do in the examples above, but they should be similar.
The switch positions on the
.
.
Example of Eight Dip Switches with Two Positions
.
A switch in the up position could be labeled as ???Up,??? ???+,??? or ???On.???
A switch in the down position could be labeled as ???Down,??? ??????,??? or ???Off.???
A switch in the middle position could be labeled as ???Middle,??? ???0,??? or ???Neutral.???
2.Write down the eight to 12 switch settings from left to right as follows:
. When a switch is in the up position, write ???Left.???
.When a switch is in the down position, write ???Right.???
.If a switch is set between the up and down position, write ???Middle.???
The switch settings written down in Step 2 now become the button strokes to be entered into the Universal Home Remote in Step 4. Be sure to enter the switch settings written down in Step 2, in order from left to right, into the Universal Home Remote, when completing Step 4.
3.From inside your vehicle, first firmly press all three buttons at the same time for about three seconds. Release the buttons to put the Universal Home Remote into programming mode.
4.The indicator lights will blink slowly. Enter each switch setting from Step 2 into your vehicle's Universal Home Remote. You will have two and
.If you wrote ???Left,??? press the left button in the vehicle.
.If you wrote ???Right,??? press the right button in the vehicle.
.If you wrote ???Middle,??? press the middle button in the vehicle.
5.After entering all of the switch positions, again, firmly press and release all three buttons at the same time. The indicator lights will turn on.
6.Press and hold the button that will be used to control the garage door until the garage door moves. The indicator light above the selected button should slowly blink. This button may need to be held for up to 55 seconds.
7.Immediately release the button when the garage door moves. The indicator light will blink rapidly until programming is complete.
8.Press and release the same button again. The garage door should move, confirming that programming is successful and complete.
To program another Fixed Code device such as an additional garage door opener, a security device,
or home automation device, repeat Steps
Using Universal Home Remote
Press and hold the appropriate button for at least half of a second. The indicator light will come on while the signal is being transmitted.
Reprogramming Universal Home
Remote Buttons
Any of the three buttons can be reprogrammed by repeating the instructions.
Erasing Universal Home Remote
Buttons
The programmed buttons should be erased when the vehicle is sold or the lease ends.
To erase either Rolling Code or Fixed Code on the Universal Home Remote device:
1.Press and hold the two outside buttons at the same time for approximately 20 seconds, until the indicator lights, located directly above the buttons, begin to blink rapidly.
2.Once the indicator lights begin to blink, release both buttons. The codes from all buttons will be erased.
For help or information on the Universal Home Remote System, call the customer assistance phone number under Customer Assistance Offices on page 8???5.
Storage Areas
Glove Box
Lift up the glove box handle to open it. Use the key to lock and unlock the glove box.
Cupholders
There are cupholders located in the full floor console, or in the front of the center seat console. Cupholders are also located in the rear armrest. Slide the cover back to access the full floor console cupholder. Fold open the front of the console to access the center seat console cupholder.
Front Storage Area
To access the front storage area, push down and then release. Push up and forward to remove.
Center Console Storage
If the vehicle has a full floor console it has two storage areas. Lift the left lever located in the front of the armrest lid to access the upper storage tray. Lift the right lever to access the lower storage area. If the vehicle has a center seat console it will have two storage areas. Press the button located on the front of
the armrest and lift the armrest cover to access the upper storage area. Pull the strap located behind the cup holder to access the lower storage area.
There may be a USB port available in the center console. See Radio(s) on page 4???66 for more information.
Center Flex Storage Unit
This vehicle may have a center flex storage unit that includes a front center seat with a lap belt and an underseat storage compartment. The center seatback can also be used as an armrest. Cupholders are also located at the front edge of the storage unit and can be accessed by folding the compartment forward.
Pull the handle rearward to open a storage compartment and access the accessory power outlet. Pull out to remove.
When not being used, the center seat lap belt can be stored in the underseat storage compartment.
Floor Mats
{ WARNING:
If a floor mat is the wrong size or is not properly installed, it can interfere with the accelerator pedal and/or brake pedal. Interference with the pedals can cause unintended acceleration and/or increased stopping distance which can cause a crash and injury. Make sure the floor mat does not interfere with the accelerator or brake pedal.
Use the following guidelines for proper floor mat usage.
.The original equipment floor mats were designed for your vehicle. If the floor mats need replacing, it is recommended that GM certified floor mats be purchased.
.Use the floor mat with the correct side up. Do not turn it over.
.Do not place anything on top of the driver side floor mat.
.Use only a single floor mat on the driver side.
. Do not place one floor mat on top of another. The driver side floor mat is held in place by two hooks.
Removing and Replacing the Floor Mats
1.Pull up on the rear of the mat to remove it from the hooks.
2.Reinstall the floor mat by lining up the openings in the floor mat over the hooks and push it down into position.
3.Make sure the floor mat is properly secured and verify that it does not interfere with the accelerator or brake pedals.
Rear Seat Armrest
This vehicle has a rear seat armrest with cupholders. Pull the tab on the armrest forward, to access it.
Convenience Net
Use the convenience net, located in the rear, to store small loads as far forward as possible. The net should not be used to store heavy loads.
Sunroof
If your vehicle has a power sunroof, the switches are located on the headliner.
To
To close the sunroof, press the front of the driver side switch to the second detent position, and release.
To vent the sunroof press and hold the back of the passenger side switch until the vent reaches the desired position. Press the front of the passenger side switch to close the sunroof.
If an object is in the path of the sunroof while it is closing, the
Dirt and debris may collect on the sunroof seal or in the tracks that could cause an issue with sunroof operation, noise or plug the water drainage system. Periodically open the sunroof and remove any obstacles or loose debris. Wipe the sunroof seal and roof sealing area using a clean cloth, mild soap, and water. Do not remove grease from sunroof.
Section 4 Instrument Panel
Instrument Panel Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Entry Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Delayed Entry Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Theater Dimming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Delayed Exit Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Perimeter Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Front Reading Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Electric Power Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Inadvertent Power Battery Saver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Battery
Accessory Power Outlet(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Ashtray(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Climate Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Dual Automatic Climate Control System . . . . . . .
Outlet Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Passenger Compartment Air Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Warning Lights, Gauges, and Indicators . . . . . . . .
Instrument Panel Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Speedometer and Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Trip Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Safety Belt Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Section 4 Instrument Panel
Airbag Readiness Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Charging System Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Brake System Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Antilock Brake System (ABS) Warning Light . . .
Traction Control System (TCS) Warning
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
StabiliTrak?? Indicator Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Lane Departure Warning (LDW) Light . . . . . . . . . .
Engine Coolant Temperature Warning Light . . . .
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge . . . . . . . . . . .
Tire Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Malfunction Indicator Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Oil Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Security Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Front Fog Lamp Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Cruise Control Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Highbeam On Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Fuel Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Driver Information Center (DIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
DIC Operation and Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
DIC Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
DIC Warnings and Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
DIC Vehicle Customization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Audio System(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Setting the Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Radio(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Using an MP3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
XM Radio Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Navigation/Radio System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Bluetooth?? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Audio Steering Wheel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Radio Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Backglass Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
XM??? Satellite Radio Antenna System . . . . . . . . .
Instrument Panel Overview
Hazard Warning Flashers
The hazard warning flashers let you warn others that you have a problem.
The hazard warning flasher button is located in the center of the instrument panel above the radio.
|: Press to make the front and rear turn signal lamps flash on and off. Press the button again to turn the flashers off.
When the hazard warning flashers are on, the turn signals will not work.
Horn
Press near or on the horn symbols on the steering wheel pad to sound the horn.
Tilt Wheel
The tilt lever is located on the left side of the steering column.
To adjust the steering wheel:
1.Hold the wheel and pull the lever toward you.
2.Move the steering wheel up or down.
3.Release the lever to lock the wheel in place. Do not adjust the steering wheel while driving.
Power Tilt Wheel and Telescopic
Steering Column
For vehicles with a power tilt control, it is located on the left hand side of the steering column.
To adjust the steering wheel, push the control up, down, forward or backward.
Do not adjust the steering wheel while driving.
Heated Steering Wheel
For vehicles with a heated steering wheel, the button for this feature is located on the steering wheel.
( : Press to turn the heated steering wheel on or off. A light on the button displays when the feature is turned on.
The steering wheel takes about three minutes to start heating.
Turn Signal/Multifunction Lever
The lever on the left side of the steering column includes the following:
G: Turn and
23: Headlamp
N: Windshield Wipers
L: Windshield Washer
Information for these features is on the pages following.
Turn and
An arrow on the instrument panel cluster flashes in the direction of the turn or lane change.
For vehicles with the side blind zone alert system, an arrow in the outside mirror flashes when the turn signal is used. See Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) on
page 3???34 for more information.
Move the lever all the way up or down to signal a turn.
Raise or lower the lever until the arrow starts to flash to signal a lane change. Hold it there until the lane change is complete. If the lever is briefly pressed and released, the turn signal will flash three times.
The lever returns to its starting position when it is released.
If after signaling a turn or lane change the arrow flashes rapidly or does not come on, a signal bulb may be burned out.
Have the bulbs replaced. If the bulb is not burned out, check the fuse. See Fuses and Circuit Breakers on
page 6???106.
Turn Signal On Chime
If the turn signal is left on, a warning chime sounds and the Driver Information Center (DIC) will display TURN SIGNAL ON after driving about a mile as a reminder to turn it off. See DIC Warnings and Messages on
page 4???47.
Headlamp
To change the headlamps from low beam to high beam, push the turn signal lever away from you. To change from high beam to low beam, pull the turn signal lever toward you.
While the high beams are on, this light located on the instrument panel cluster will also be on.
This feature lets you use the
Pull the turn signal lever toward you briefly to
If the headlamps are off or on low beam, the
Windshield Wipers
The windshield wiper lever is located on the left side of the steering column.
Turn the band with the wiper symbol on it to control the windshield wipers.
8 (Mist): For a single wiping cycle, hold it on mist until the wipers start, then release. The wipers stop after one wipe. Several wipes, hold the band longer.
6 (Delay): Use to set the delay time between wipe cycles. The wiper speed can be set for a long or short delay between wipes. The closer the band is set to the top of the lever, the shorter the delay.
6 (Low Speed): Slow wipes.
1 (High Speed): Fast wipes.
9 (Off): Turns the wipers off.
Clear ice and snow from the wiper blades before using them. If frozen to the windshield, carefully loosen or thaw them. Damaged blades should be replaced.
Heavy snow or ice can overload the wiper motor. A circuit breaker will stop the motor until it cools.
The vehicle has
Windshield Washer
{ WARNING:
In freezing weather, do not use your washer until the windshield is warmed. Otherwise the washer fluid can form ice on the windshield, blocking your vision.
J(Washer Fluid): Press and release this paddle, located at the top of the turn signal/multifunction lever, to spray washer fluid on the windshield. The wipers will clear the windshield and either stop or return to the preset speed. For more washer cycles, press and hold the paddle.
Cruise Control
With cruise control, you can maintain a speed of about 40 km/h (25 mph) or more without keeping your foot on the accelerator. Cruise control does not work at speeds below about 40 km/h (25 mph).
{ WARNING:
Cruise control can be dangerous where you cannot drive safely at a steady speed. So, do not use the cruise control on winding roads or in heavy traffic.
Cruise control can be dangerous on slippery roads. On such roads, fast changes in tire traction can cause excessive wheel slip, and you could lose control. Do not use cruise control on slippery roads.
If your vehicle has the Traction Control System (TCS) and the cruise control is on, TCS will begin to limit wheel spin and the cruise control automatically turns off. See Traction Control System (TCS) on page 5??? 6. When road conditions allow you to safely use it again, the cruise control can be turned back on.
The cruise control buttons are located on left side of the steering wheel.
T (On/Off): Press to turn the cruise control on or off. The indicator is lit when cruise control is on.
+ RES (Resume/Accelerate): Press briefly to make the vehicle resume to a previously set speed, or press and hold to accelerate.
[ (Cancel): Press to disengage cruise control without erasing the set speed from memory.
Setting Cruise Control
If the cruise button is on when not in use, it could get bumped and go into cruise when not desired. Keep the cruise control switch off when cruise is not being used.
The cruise control light on the instrument panel cluster comes on after the cruise control has been set to the desired speed. See Instrument Panel Cluster on page 4???27.
1.Press the T button to turn the cruise system on.
2.Get up to the desired speed.
3.Press and release the SET??? button located on the steering wheel.
4.Take your foot off the accelerator.
Resuming a Set Speed
If cruise control is set at a desired speed and then the brakes are applied, the cruise control is disengaged without erasing the set speed from memory.
Once the vehicle speed is 40 km/h (25 mph) or greater, press the +RES button on the steering wheel. The vehicle returns to the previously selected speed and stays there.
Increasing Speed While Using Cruise
Control
If the cruise control system is already activated,
.Press and hold the +RES button on the steering wheel until the desired speed is reached, then release it.
.To increase vehicle speed in small increments, press the +RES button. Each time this is done, the vehicle goes about 1.6 km/h (1 mph) faster.
Reducing Speed While Using Cruise
Control
If the cruise control system is already activated,
.Press and hold the SET??? button on the steering wheel until the lower speed desired is reached, then release it.
.To slow down in small amounts, press the SET??? button briefly. Each time this is done, the vehicle goes about 1.6 km/h (1 mph) slower.
Passing Another Vehicle While Using
Cruise Control
Use the accelerator pedal to increase vehicle speed. When you take your foot off the pedal, the vehicle will slow down to the cruise speed you set earlier.
Using Cruise Control on Hills
How well the cruise control will work on hills depends upon the vehicle speed, load and the steepness of the hills. When going up steep hills, you might have to step on the accelerator pedal to maintain your speed. When going downhill, you might have to brake or shift to a lower gear to keep your speed down. If the brakes are applied the cruise control will turn off.
Ending Cruise Control
There are three ways to end cruise control:
.To disengage cruise control, step lightly on the brake pedal, or
.Press the [ button on the steering wheel.
.To turn off the cruise control, press the T button on the steering wheel.
Erasing Speed Memory
The cruise control set speed memory is erased from memory by pressing Tor if the ignition is turned off.
Exterior Lamps
The exterior lamps control is located on the instrument panel to the left of the steering wheel.
It controls the following systems:
.Headlamps
.Taillamps
.Parking Lamps
.License Plate Lamps
.Instrument Panel Lights
.Fog Lamps
The exterior lamps control has four positions:
O(Off): Turn the control to this position to turn off the exterior lamps.
AUTO (Automatic): Turn the control to this position to automatically turn on the headlamps at normal brightness, together with the following:
.Parking Lamps
.Instrument Panel Lights
; (Parking Lamps): Turn the control to this position to turn on the parking lamps together with the following:
.Taillamps
.License Plate Lamps
.Instrument Panel Lights
2 (Headlamps): Turn the control to this position to turn on the headlamps together with the following lamps listed below. A warning chime sounds if the driver's door is opened while the ignition switch is off and the headlamps are on.
.Parking Lamps
.License Plate Lamps
.Instrument Panel Lights
#(Fog Lamps): Push the exterior lamps control in to turn on the fog lamps.
See Fog Lamps on page 4???12.
Wiper Activated Headlamps
This feature activates the headlamps and parking lamps after the windshield wipers are turned on and have completed eight wipe cycles within four minutes.
When the ignition is turned to LOCK/OFF, the
Headlamps on Reminder
If you leave the exterior lamp buttons for the headlamps or parking lamps on, remove the key from the ignition and open the driver's door, you will hear a continuous warning chime. The chime will turn off when the lamps are turned off.
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL)
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) can make it easier for others to see the front of your vehicle during the day. Fully functional daytime running lamps are required on all vehicles first sold in Canada.
A light sensor on top of the instrument panel monitors the exterior light level for the operation of DRL, so be sure it is not covered.
The DRL system makes the
.The ignition is on with the engine running.
.The exterior lamp button for the headlamps is off.
When the DRL are on, only the
When it is dark enough outside, the
To turn off all exterior lighting at night when the vehicle is parked, turn the exterior lamp control to the off position. See Exterior Lamps on page 4???10 for more information.
The regular headlamp system should be turned on when needed.
Fog Lamps
The fog lamps button is on the exterior lamps control to the left of the steering column.
# (Fog Lamps): Press to turn the fog lamps on or off. A light comes on in the instrument panel cluster when the fog lamps are in use. See Instrument Panel Cluster on page 4???27. The ignition must be in the ON/RUN position for the fog lamps to work.
The fog lamps will go off when the headlamps are changed to
Some localities have laws that require the headlamps to be on along with the fog lamps.
Cornering Lamps
For vehicles with this feature, the cornering lamps come on when: the headlamps or parking lamps are on, the vehicle is not in P (Park), and you signal a turn with the turn signal/multifunction lever. They provide more light for cornering.
Exterior Lighting Battery Saver
If the exterior lamp button has been left on, the exterior lamps will turn off about 10 minutes after the ignition is turned to LOCK/OFF and a door has been opened. This protects against draining the battery if the headlamps or parking lamps are accidentally left on. If the lamps need
to be left on for more than 10 minutes, use the exterior lamp control to turn the lamps back on after the ignition is turned to LOCK/OFF and any door is opened.
Instrument Panel Brightness
D (Instrument Panel Brightness): This feature controls the brightness of the instrument panel lights.
The knob for this control is located next to the exterior lamps control.
Push the knob in and release when it pops out. Turn the knob clockwise to increase the brightness of the instrument panel lights and counter clockwise to decrease the brightness. Turning the knob completely clockwise to the detent will turn on the courtesy lamps.
Courtesy Lamps
When any door is opened, several lamps turn on making it easier for you to enter and exit the vehicle. Turn the instrument panel brightness control completely clockwise to manually turn on these lamps.
Entry Lighting
If it is dark enough outside when you press the unlock button on the remote keyless entry transmitter, the interior courtesy lamps will turn on and stay on for about 40 seconds. The lamps can be turned off immediately
by pressing the lock button on the remote keyless entry transmitter, turning the ignition key to ON/RUN or activating the power door locks.
Delayed Entry Lighting
The interior lamps will turn on if you open the door when it is dark enough outside. When you close the door with the ignition off, the interior lamps will stay on for up to 25 seconds or until the ignition is turned to an on position. When the lamps turn off as a result of the 25 second timer or the ignition switch being turned on, the lighting will deactivate by way of the theater dimming effect. Locking the doors will override the delayed entry lighting feature and the lamps will turn off right away.
Theater Dimming
This feature allows for a three to five second fade out of the courtesy lamps instead of immediate turn off.
Delayed Exit Lighting
If it is dark enough outside when you remove the key from the ignition, the interior lamps will turn on and stay on for about 25 seconds. This will give you time to find the door pull handle or lock switches. Once the key is inserted into the ignition, the exit lighting will be cancelled and the lighting will fade out.
Perimeter Lighting
If it is dark enough outside when the unlock button on the remote keyless entry transmitter is pressed, the DRL, parking lamps and
This feature can be programmed on for various amounts of time in seconds for each transmitter.
See DIC Vehicle Customization on page 4???56 for information on programming.
Front Reading Lamps
The front reading lamps are located on the headliner. Press the button near each lamp to turn them on or off.
Electric Power Management
The vehicle has Electric Power Management (EPM) that estimates the battery's temperature and state of charge. It then adjusts the voltage for best performance and extended life of the battery.
When the battery's state of charge is low, the voltage is raised slightly to quickly bring the charge back up. When the state of charge is high, the voltage is lowered slightly to prevent overcharging. If the vehicle has a voltmeter gauge or a voltage display on the Driver Information Center (DIC), you may see the voltage move up or down. This is normal. If there is a problem, an alert will be displayed.
The battery can be discharged at idle if the electrical loads are very high. This is true for all vehicles. This is because the generator (alternator) may not be spinning fast enough at idle to produce all the power that is needed for very high electrical loads.
A high electrical load occurs when several of the following are on, such as: headlamps, high beams, fog lamps, rear window defogger, climate control fan at high speed, heated seats, engine cooling fans, trailer loads, and loads plugged into accessory power outlets.
EPM works to prevent excessive discharge of the battery. It does this by balancing the generator's output and the vehicle's electrical needs. It can increase engine idle speed to generate more power, whenever needed. It can temporarily reduce the power demands of some accessories.
Normally, these actions occur in steps or levels, without being noticeable. In rare cases at the highest levels of corrective action, this action may be noticeable to the driver. If so, a Driver Information Center (DIC) message might be displayed, such as BATTERY SAVER ACTIVE, BATTERY VOLTAGE LOW, or LOW BATTERY. If this message is displayed, it is recommended that the driver reduce the electrical loads as much as possible. See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 4???47.
Inadvertent Power Battery Saver
This feature is designed to protect your vehicle's battery against drainage from the interior lamps, or garage door opener. When the ignition is turned off, the power to these features will automatically turn off after
10 minutes. Power will be restored for an additional
10 minutes if any door is opened, the trunk is opened or the courtesy lamp switch is turned on.
Battery
This feature helps prevent the battery from being drained, if the interior courtesy lamps, reading/map lamps, visor vanity lamps or trunk lamp are accidentally left on. If any of these lamps are left on, they automatically turn off after 10 minutes, if the ignition is off. The lamps will not come back on again until one of the following occurs:
.The ignition is turned on.
.The exterior lamps control is turned off, then on again.
The headlamps will timeout after 10 minutes, if they are manually turned on with the ignition on or off.
Accessory Power Outlet(s)
Accessory power outlets can be used to plug in electrical equipment, such as a cell phone or MP3 player.
The vehicle may have up to three power outlets depending on the type of front seat installed. If the vehicle has front bucket seats with a center console, there are two outlets inside the center console storage bin, one accessory power outlet and one USB port outlet. An extra accessory power outlet can be found under the climate control system next to the ashtray.
Remove the cover to access and replace when not in use.
{ WARNING:
Power is always supplied to the outlets. Do not leave electrical equipment plugged in when the vehicle is not in use because the vehicle could catch fire and cause injury or death.
Notice: Leaving electrical equipment plugged in for an extended period of time while the vehicle is off will drain the battery. Always unplug electrical equipment when not in use and do not plug in equipment that exceeds the maximum 20 ampere rating.
Certain electrical accessories may not be compatible with the accessory power outlet and could overload vehicle or adapter fuses. If a problem is experienced, see your dealer.
When adding electrical equipment, be sure to follow the proper installation instructions included with the equipment. See
page 6???106.
Notice: Hanging heavy equipment from the power outlet can cause damage not covered by the vehicle warranty. The power outlets are designed for accessory power plugs only, such as cell phone charge cords.
Ashtray(s)
Notice: If papers, pins, or other flammable items are put in the ashtray, hot cigarettes or other smoking materials could ignite them and possibly damage the vehicle. Never put flammable items in the ashtray.
For vehicles without the floor console, pull the tray located below the climate controls to reveal the ashtray. The ashtray can be removed by pulling on the ledge located at the top of the ashtray.
The vehicles with a full floor console do not have an ashtray. There is a storage bin below the climate control system. For more information, see Front Storage Area on page 3???47.
Climate Controls
Climate Control System
The heating, cooling, and ventilation for the vehicle can be controlled with this system.
For vehicles with the remote start feature, when activated, the climate control system heats or cools the inside of the vehicle with the settings used before the vehicle was turned off. The heated seats, if the vehicle has them, and the rear window defogger will also be turned on when it is cold outside. The cooled seat setting is not activated during a remote start. Normal
operation of the system will return after the key is turned to the ON/RUN position. See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation on page 3??? 4 for more information.
Operation
( (Off): Turns the climate control system off. Outside air still enters the vehicle and is directed to the floor. The airflow direction and temperature can be adjusted.
Temperature Control: Turn clockwise or counterclockwise to increase or decrease the temperature.
9 (Fan Control): Turn clockwise or counterclockwise to increase or decrease the fan speed. The fan speed is temporarily reduced between the transition to a new mode. The fan will resume when the new mode is complete.
If the airflow seems low when the fan speed is at the highest setting, the passenger compartment air filter may need to be replaced. For more information, see
Passenger Compartment Air Filter on page 4???24 and Scheduled Maintenance on page 7???3.
Air Delivery Mode Control: Turn clockwise or counterclockwise to change the direction of the airflow in the vehicle.
To change the current mode, select one of the following:
H (Vent): Air is directed to the instrument panel outlets.
)
6 (Floor): Air is directed to the floor outlets, with some air directed to the windshield and side window outlets.
If recirculation is selected while in this mode, it stays on for three minutes to reduce windshield fogging.
- (Floor/Defog): This clears the windows of fog or moisture. Air is directed to the windshield and side window outlets and to the floor outlets. The system runs the air conditioning compressor unless the outside temperature is near or below freezing.
0 (Defrost): This mode clears the windshield of fog or frost more quickly. Air is directed to the windshield and side window outlets. The system runs the air conditioning compressor unless the outside temperature is near or below freezing.
# (Air Conditioning): Press to turn the air conditioning system on or off. An indicator light below the button comes on to show that this mode is on. Air conditioning can be selected in any mode as long as the fan knob is not in the off position.
On hot days during the vehicle's initial
For quicker cool down on hot days, do the following:
1.Select H.
2.Select h.
3.Select #.
4.Select the coolest temperature.
5.Select the highest fan speed.
The
h (Recirculation): Press to turn the recirculation mode on. An indicator light below the button comes on to show that this mode is on. This mode recirculates and helps to quickly cool the air inside the vehicle.
It can be used to prevent outside air and odors from entering the vehicle. This mode cannot be selected while in the defog or defrost modes. If you try to select the recirculation mode, the indicator light flashes three times and turns off.
Operation in this mode during periods of high humidity and cool outside temperatures may result in increased window fogging. If window fogging is experienced, select the defrost mode.
Rear Window Defogger
The rear window defogger uses a warming grid to remove fog from the rear window.
< (Rear Window Defogger): Press to turn the rear window defogger on or off. An indicator light below the button comes on to show that the rear window defogger is on. Be sure to clear as much snow from the rear window as possible.
The rear window defogger only works when the ignition is in ON/RUN. The rear window defogger stays on for about 20 minutes after the button is pressed if traveling at slow speeds. At higher vehicle speeds, the rear defogger may stay on continuously. If turned on again, the defogger only runs for about 10 minutes before turning off. The defogger can be turned off by pressing the button again, by turning the ignition to ACC/ ACCESSORY or ON/RUN, or by turning off the engine.
If the vehicle has heated outside rearview mirrors, the mirrors heat to help clear fog or frost from the surface of the mirror when the rear window defogger is on. See
Outside Heated Mirrors on page 3???32 for more
information.
Notice: Do not use anything sharp on the inside of the rear window. If you do, you could cut or damage the warming grid, and the repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Do not attach a temporary vehicle license, tape, a decal or anything similar to the defogger grid.
Dual Automatic Climate Control
System
The heating, cooling, and ventilation for the vehicle can be controlled with this system.
For vehicles with the remote start feature and it is activated, the climate control system heats or cools the inside of the vehicle, with the settings used before the vehicle was turned off. The heated seats, if the vehicle has them, and the rear window defogger will be turned on by the climate control system when it is cold outside. The cooled seat setting is not activated during a remote start. Normal operation of the system will return after the key is turned to the ON/RUN position. See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation on page 3??? 4 for more information.
Automatic Operation
AUTO (Automatic Fan): When AUTO is selected on the fan control, the system automatically adjusts the fan speed. If the OnStar?? system is activated when this position is selected, the fan speed will lower.
AUTO (Automatic Mode)
1.Turn the fan control to AUTO.
2.Turn the mode control to AUTO.
3.Adjust the temperature to a comfortable setting between 68??F (21??C) and 78??F (26??C).
Choosing the coldest or warmest temperature setting will not cause the system to heat or cool any faster. In cold weather, the system starts at reduced fan speeds to avoid blowing cold air into the vehicle until warmer air is available. The system will start out blowing air to the floor, but may change modes automatically as the vehicle warms up to maintain the chosen temperature setting. The length of time needed to warm the interior depends on the outside temperature.
4.Wait a few minutes for the system to automatically regulate. Then adjust the temperature as necessary to find your comfort setting.
Do not cover the solar sensor located in the center of the instrument panel, near the windshield. For more information on the solar sensor, see ???Sensors??? later in this section.
After the vehicle is started, the display shows the interior temperature settings.
When the ENG/MET (English/metric) button on the Driver Information Center (DIC) is pressed, the display shows readings in Fahrenheit or Celsius. Use the ENG/ MET button to toggle between the readings.
AUTO (Automatic Air Conditioning): If AUTO is selected on the fan or mode control, the system automatically controls the air conditioning compressor. The A/C compressor runs automatically even at cool outside temperatures in order to dehumidify the air. The A/C indicator light is lit when the system is operating automatically. Press the A/C button on the fan control to turn off the A/C. To clear windows better in defog or defrost modes, the A/C compressor runs automatically in damp cool conditions.
h (Auto Recirculation) : If AUTO is selected on either the fan or mode control, the system automatically controls the supply of fresh outside air or recirculates the interior air to cool the car faster. The indicator light on the recirculation button will light whenever the system switches to recirculation. You may force outside
air by pressing the outside air button. The next time AUTO fan or mode is selected, it will reset back to AUTO operation.
Manual Operation
9(Off): Turns the climate control system off. Outside air still enters the vehicle and is directed to the floor. The airflow direction and temperature can be adjusted.
If the temperature is adjusted while the system is off, the display will light to show the current settings.
w x (Driver Temperature Controls) : Press these buttons next to the fan control to increase or decrease the temperature inside the vehicle.
w x (Passenger Temperature Controls): Press these buttons next to the mode control to increase or decrease the temperature for the front passenger. If the passenger climate control system is off, pressing one of these buttons turns it on.
9 (Fan Control): Turn clockwise or counterclockwise to increase or decrease the fan speed. Turning this control completely counterclockwise turns on the automatic fan operation.
If the airflow seems low when the fan speed is at the highest setting, the passenger compartment air filter may need to be replaced. For more information, see
Passenger Compartment Air Filter on page 4???24 and Scheduled Maintenance on page 7???3.
Air Delivery Mode Control: Turn clockwise or counterclockwise to change the direction of the airflow in the vehicle.
To change the current mode, select one of the following:
F (Vent): Air is directed to the instrument panel outlets.
*
7 (Floor): Air is directed to the floor outlets, with some air directed to the windshield and side window outlets.
If recirculation is selected while in this mode, it stays on for three minutes to reduce windshield fogging.
W (Floor/Defog): This mode clears the windows of fog or moisture. Air is directed to the floor outlets, with some air directed to the windshield and side window outlets. The system turns off recirculation and runs the
0 (Defrost): This mode removes fog or frost from the windshield more quickly. Air is directed to the windshield and the side window outlets. The system automatically turns off recirculation and runs the
# (Air Conditioning): Press to turn the air conditioning system on or off and override the automatic system. An indicator light below the button comes on to show that this mode is on.
The air conditioning system removes moisture from the air, so a small amount of water might drip under the vehicle while idling or after turning off the engine. This is normal.
: (Outside Air): Press to let outside air enter the vehicle. An indicator light comes on to show this mode
is on. Pressing ? cancels this mode.
? (Recirculation): Press to turn the recirculation mode on. An indicator light below the button comes on to show that this mode is on. This mode recirculates and helps to quickly cool the air inside the vehicle.
It can be used to prevent outside air and odors from entering the vehicle. This mode cannot be selected while in the defog or defrost modes. If you try to select the recirculation mode, the indicator light flashes three times and turns off.
Operation in this mode during periods of high humidity and cool outside temperatures may result in increased window fogging. If window fogging is experienced, select the defrost mode.
PASS (Passenger Climate Control): Press to turn the passenger climate control systems on or off.
When the passenger climate control system is on, the passenger temperature setting is displayed.
If the PASS button is pressed to turn the passenger temperature setting off, the driver temperature setting controls the temperature for the entire vehicle.
Sensors
The solar sensor, located in the defrost grille, in the middle of the instrument panel, monitors the solar radiation. Do not cover the solar sensor or the system will not work properly.
There is also an interior temperature sensor located next to the steering wheel that measures the temperature of the air inside the vehicle.
There is also an exterior temperature sensor located behind the front grille. This sensor reads the outside air temperature and helps maintain the temperature inside the vehicle. Any cover on the front of the vehicle could cause a false temperature reading to display.
In order to prevent false temperature readings at startup, the displayed temperature will not change until the following occurs:
.Vehicle speed is above 10 mph (16 km/h) for five minutes.
.Vehicle speed is above 32 mph (51 km/h) for two and a half minutes.
The climate control system uses the information from these sensors to maintain your comfort setting by adjusting the outlet temperature, fan speed, and the air delivery mode. The system may also supply cooler air to the side of the vehicle facing the sun. The recirculation mode will also be used as needed to maintain cool outlet temperatures.
Rear Window Defogger
The rear window defogger uses a warming grid to remove fog or frost from the rear window.
< (Rear Defogger): Press to turn the rear window defogger on or off. An indicator light below the button comes on to show that the rear window defogger is on. Be sure to clear as much snow from the rear window as possible.
The rear window defogger only works when the ignition is in ON/RUN. The rear window defogger stays on for about 20 minutes after the button is pressed if the vehicle is traveling at slower vehicle speeds. At higher vehicle speeds the rear window defogger may stay on continuously. If turned on again, the defogger only runs for about 10 minutes before turning off. The defogger can be turned off by pressing the button again, by turning the ignition to ACC/ACCESSORY or ON/RUN, or by turning off the engine.
The heated outside rearview mirrors will heat to help clear fog or frost from the surface of the mirror when the rear window defogger is on. See Outside Heated Mirrors on page 3???32 for more information.
Notice: Do not use a razor blade or sharp object to clear the inside rear window. Do not adhere anything to the defogger grid lines in the rear glass. These actions may damage the rear defogger. Repairs would not be covered by your warranty.
Outlet Adjustment
Use the levers, located in the middle of the front outlets, to change the direction of the airflow. Use the thumbwheel located between the outlets to turn them on and off.
If the vehicle has rear seat outlets, adjust the direction of the airflow using the lever in the center of each outlet.
Operation Tips
.Clear away any ice, snow, or leaves from the air inlets at the base of the windshield that could block the flow of air into the vehicle.
.Use of
.Keep the path under the front seats clear of objects to help circulate the air inside the vehicle better.
Passenger Compartment Air Filter
Outside air is routed through a passenger compartment air filter before entering the vehicle. This filter removes certain particles from the air, including pollen and dust particles. The filter should be replaced as part of routine scheduled maintenance. See Scheduled Maintenance on page 7??? 3 for when to replace the filter.
The access panel for the passenger compartment air filter is located under the hood near the windshield, on the passenger's side of the vehicle.
To access the passenger compartment air filter, do the following:
1. Press the tabs back and left to remove the cover.
2.Insert a tool behind the push pin located on the inboard side of the air filter compartment to carefully pry the pin out.
3.To remove the air filter, insert a tool between the air filter and the compartment wall on the outboard side of the vehicle. Then, push in to flatten the pin holding the air filter in place. Gently remove the air filter and any loose debris that may be inside the air filter compartment.
4.Insert the new air filter by pushing until you hear a click. Reinstall the push pin and snap the cover into place.
Warning Lights, Gauges, and
Indicators
Warning lights and gauges can signal that something is wrong before it becomes serious enough to cause an expensive repair or replacement. Paying attention to the warning lights and gauges could prevent injury.
Warning lights come on when there might be or there is a problem with one of the vehicle's functions. Some warning lights come on briefly when the engine is started to indicate they are working.
Gauges can indicate when there might be or there is a problem with one of the vehicle's functions. Often gauges and warning lights work together to indicate a problem with the vehicle.
When one of the warning lights comes on and stays on while driving, or when one of the gauges shows there could be a problem, check the section that explains what to do. Follow this manual's advice. Waiting to do repairs can be costly and even dangerous.
Instrument Panel Cluster
English Super Model Shown, Metric and Base Similar
Speedometer and Odometer
The speedometer shows the vehicle speed in both miles per hour (mph) and kilometers per hour (km/h). The odometer shows how far the vehicle has been driven, in either miles or kilometers.
This vehicle has a tamper resistant odometer.
If the vehicle needs a new odometer installed, the new one can be set to the mileage total of the old odometer. If this is not possible, it is set to zero and a label must be put on the driver's door to show the old mileage reading when the new odometer was installed.
Trip Odometer
A trip odometer show how far the vehicle has been driven since the odometer was last set to zero. See
Driver Information Center (DIC) on page 4???40 for information on resetting the trip odometer.
Tachometer
The tachometer displays the engine speed in revolutions per minute (rpm).
Safety Belt Reminders
Driver Safety Belt Reminder Light
When the engine is started, a chime sounds for several seconds to remind a driver to fasten the safety belt, unless the driver safety belt is already buckled.
The safety belt light comes on and stays on for several seconds, then flashes for several more.
This chime and light are repeated if the driver remains unbuckled and the vehicle is in motion. If the driver safety belt is already buckled, neither the chime nor the light comes on.
Passenger Safety Belt Reminder Light
For vehicles equipped with the passenger safety belt reminder light, several seconds after the engine is started, a chime sounds for several seconds to remind the front passenger to buckle their safety belt. The passenger safety belt light, located on the instrument panel, comes on and stays on for several seconds and then flashes for several more.
This chime and light are repeated if the passenger remains unbuckled and the vehicle is in motion.
If the passenger safety belt is buckled, neither the chime nor the light comes on.
The front passenger safety belt warning light and chime may turn on if an object is put on the seat such as a briefcase, handbag, grocery bag, laptop or other electronic device. To turn off the warning light and or chime, remove the object from the seat or buckle the safety belt.
Airbag Readiness Light
The system checks the airbag's electrical system for possible malfunctions. If the light stays on it indicates there is an electrical problem. The system check includes the airbag sensor, the pretensioners, the airbag modules, the wiring and the crash sensing and diagnostic module. For more information on the airbag system, see Airbag System on page 2???56.
The airbag readiness light flashes for a few seconds when the engine is started. If the light does not come on then, have it fixed immediately.
{ WARNING:
If the airbag readiness light stays on after the vehicle is started or comes on while driving, it means the airbag system might not be working properly. The airbags in the vehicle might not inflate in a crash, or they could even inflate without a crash. To help avoid injury, have the vehicle serviced right away.
If there is a problem with the airbag system, an airbag Driver Information Center (DIC) message can also come on. See DIC Warnings and Messages on
page 4???47 for more information.
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator
The vehicle has the passenger sensing system. See
Passenger Sensing System on page 2???65 for important safety information. The overhead console has a passenger airbag status indicator.
When the vehicle is started, the passenger airbag status indicator will light ON and OFF, or the symbol for on and off, for several seconds as a system check.
If you are using remote start to start the vehicle from a distance, if equipped, you may not see the system check.
Then, after several more seconds, the status indicator will light either ON or OFF, or either the on or off symbol, to let you know the status of the right front passenger frontal and
If the word ON or the on symbol is lit on the passenger airbag status indicator, it means that the right front passenger frontal airbag and
If the word OFF or the off symbol is lit on the passenger airbag status indicator, it means that the passenger sensing system has turned off the right front passenger frontal and seat???mounted side impact airbag.
If, after several seconds, both status indicator lights remain on, or if there are no lights at all, there may be a problem with the lights or the passenger sensing system. See your dealer for service.
{ WARNING:
If the airbag readiness light ever comes on and stays on, it means that something may be wrong with the airbag system. To help avoid injury to yourself or others, have the vehicle serviced right away. See Airbag Readiness Light on page 4???29 for more information, including important safety information.
Charging System Light
This light comes on briefly when the ignition key is turned to START, but the engine is not running, as a check to show it is working.
If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by your dealer.
The light should go out once the engine starts. If it stays on, or comes on while driving, there could be a problem with the charging system. A charging system message in the Driver Information Center (DIC) can also appear. See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 4???47 for more information. This light could indicate that there are problems with a generator drive belt, or that there is an electrical problem. Have it checked right away. If the vehicle must be driven a short distance with the light on, turn off accessories, such as the radio and air conditioner.
Brake System Warning Light
The vehicle brake system consists of two hydraulic circuits. If one circuit is not working, the remaining circuit can still work to stop the vehicle. For normal braking performance, both circuits need to be working
If the warning light comes on, there is a brake problem. Have the brake system inspected right away.
This light should come on briefly when the engine is started. If it does not come on then, have it fixed so it will be ready to warn if there is a problem.
When the ignition is on, the brake system warning light also comes on when the parking brake is set. The light will stay on if the parking brake does not fully release. If it stays on after the parking brake is fully released, it means there is a brake problem.
{ WARNING:
The brake system might not be working properly if the brake system warning light is on. Driving with the brake system warning light on can lead to a crash. If the light is still on after the vehicle has been pulled off the road and carefully stopped, have the vehicle towed for service.
If the light comes on while driving, pull off the road and stop carefully. The pedal can be harder to push, or the pedal could go closer to the floor. It could take longer to stop. Try turning off and restarting the vehicle one or two times, if the light is still on, have the vehicle towed for service. See Towing Your Vehicle on page 5???23.
Antilock Brake System (ABS)
Warning Light
For vehicles with the Antilock Brake System (ABS), this light comes on briefly when the engine is started.
If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by your dealer. If the system is working normally the indicator light then goes off.
If the ABS light stays on, turn the ignition off. If the light comes on while driving, stop as soon as it is safely possible and turn the ignition off. Then start the engine again to reset the system. If the ABS light stays on,
or comes on again while driving, the vehicle needs service. If the regular brake system warning light is not on, the vehicle still has brakes, but not antilock brakes. If the regular brake system warning light is also on, the vehicle does not have antilock brakes and there is a problem with the regular brakes. See Brake System Warning Light on page 4???31.
For vehicles with a Driver Information Center (DIC), see
DIC Warnings and Messages on page 4???47 for all
brake related DIC messages.
Traction Control System (TCS)
Warning Light
The Traction Control System (TCS) light comes on briefly when the engine is started.
If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by your dealer. If the system is working normally the indicator light then goes off.
When the system is active, the light flashes while the system is limiting wheel spin or assisting with controlling the vehicle.
If it stays on or comes on while driving a SERVICE TRACTION CONTROL message appears in the Driver Information Center (DIC). This indicates that there could be a problem with the traction control system and the vehicle may need service. When this warning light is on and the SERVICE TRACTION CONTROL message appears on the DIC, the system does not limit
wheel spin.
If the traction control system is manually turned off, this light comes on and the TRACTION CONTROL OFF message appears on the DIC.
See Traction Control System (TCS) on page 5??? 6 and DIC Warnings and Messages on page 4???47 for more information.
StabiliTrak?? Indicator Light
The StabiliTrak Indicator Light comes on briefly while starting the engine.
If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by your dealer. If the system is working normally the indicator light will then go off.
This light may come on while the vehicle is first driven and the STABILITRAK NOT READY message will appear in the Driver Information Center (DIC). See
StabiliTrak?? System on page 5??? 6 for more information.
If the light stays on, or comes on while driving a SERVICE STABILITRAK message will appear in the DIC. This indicates that there may be a problem with
the StabiliTrak system and the vehicle may need service. When this warning light is on and the SERVICE STABILITRAK message appears on the DIC, the system will not assist with controlling the vehicle.
When the system is active, the light will flash while the system is assisting with controlling the vehicle.
See StabiliTrak?? System on page 5??? 6 and DIC Warnings and Messages on page 4???47 for more information.
Lane Departure Warning (LDW) Light
For vehicles with the lane departure warning system, this light briefly comes on green while starting the vehicle.
If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by your dealer. If the system is working normally the indicator light then goes off.
This light also comes on green if the system detects a left or right lane marking. It flashes, changes to amber, and three beeps sound, if a detected lane marking is crossed without using a turn signal. For more information, see the Index in the Navigation Manual.
Engine Coolant Temperature
Warning Light
This light comes on briefly while starting the vehicle.
If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by the dealer. If the system is working normally the indicator light goes off.
Notice: Driving with the engine coolant temperature warning light on could cause the vehicle to overheat. See Engine Overheating on page 6???35. The vehicle's engine could be damaged, and it might not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Never drive with the engine coolant temperature warning light on.
The engine coolant temperature warning light comes on when the engine has overheated.
If this happens pull over and turn off the engine as soon as possible. See Engine Overheating on page 6???35 for more information.
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge
This gauge shows the engine coolant temperature. If the pointer moves towards the H (United States) or
shaded in thermostat symbol area (Canada), the engine is too hot.
A temperature indicator light will turn on and a chime will sound.
If the vehicle has been operating under normal driving conditions, and the temperature indicator light comes on, pull off the road, stop the vehicle and turn off the engine as soon as possible.
Tire Pressure Light
For vehicles with a tire pressure monitoring system, this light comes on briefly when the engine is started. It provides information about tire pressures and the Tire Pressure Monitoring System.
When the Light is On Steady
This indicates that one or more of the tires is significantly underinflated.
A tire pressure message in the Driver Information Center (DIC), can accompany the light. See Driver Information Center (DIC) on page 4???40 for more information. Stop and check the tires as soon as it is safe to do so. If underinflated, inflate to the proper pressure. See Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 6???63 for more information.
When the Light Flashes First and Then is On Steady
This indicates that there may be a problem with the Tire Pressure Monitor System. The light flashes for about a minute and stays on steady for the remainder of the ignition cycle. This sequence repeats with every ignition cycle. See Tire Pressure Monitor Operation on
page 6???65 for more information.
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
A computer system called OBD II
It ensures that emissions are at acceptable levels for the life of the vehicle, helping to produce a cleaner environment.
This light should come on when the ignition is on, but the engine is not running, as a check to show it is working. If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by your dealer.
If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp comes on and stays on, while the engine is running, this indicates that there is an OBD II problem and service is required.
Malfunctions often are indicated by the system before any problem is apparent. Being aware of the light can prevent more serious damage to the vehicle. This system assists the service technician in correctly diagnosing any malfunction.
Notice: If the vehicle is continually driven with this light on, after a while, the emission controls might not work as well, the vehicle fuel economy might not be as good, and the engine might not run as smoothly. This could lead to costly repairs that might not be covered by the vehicle warranty.
Notice: Modifications made to the engine, transmission, exhaust, intake, or fuel system of the vehicle or the replacement of the original tires with other than those of the same Tire Performance Criteria (TPC) can affect the vehicle's emission controls and can cause this light to come on. Modifications to these systems could lead to costly repairs not covered by the vehicle warranty. This could also result in a failure to pass a required Emission Inspection/Maintenance test. See
Accessories and Modifications on page 6???3.
This light comes on during a malfunction in one of two ways:
Light Flashing: A misfire condition has been detected. A misfire increases vehicle emissions and could damage the emission control system on the vehicle. Diagnosis and service might be required.
To prevent more serious damage to the vehicle:
.Reduce vehicle speed.
.Avoid hard accelerations.
.Avoid steep uphill grades.
.If towing a trailer, reduce the amount of cargo being hauled as soon as it is possible.
If the light continues to flash, when it is safe to do so, stop the vehicle. Find a safe place to park the vehicle. Turn the vehicle off, wait at least 10 seconds, and restart the engine. If the light is still flashing, follow the previous steps and see your dealer for service as soon as possible.
Light On Steady: An emission control system malfunction has been detected on the vehicle. Diagnosis and service might be required.
An emission system malfunction might be corrected by doing the following:
.Make sure the fuel cap is fully installed. See Filling the Tank on page 6???10. The diagnostic system can determine if the fuel cap has been left off or improperly installed. A loose or missing fuel cap allows fuel to evaporate into the atmosphere. A few driving trips with the cap properly installed should turn the light off.
.If the vehicle has been driven through a deep puddle of water, the vehicle's electrical system might be wet. The condition is usually corrected when the electrical system dries out. A few driving trips should turn the light off.
.Make sure to fuel the vehicle with quality fuel. Poor fuel quality causes the engine not to run as efficiently as designed and can cause: stalling after
or stumbling on acceleration. These conditions might go away once the engine is warmed up.
If one or more of these conditions occurs, change the fuel brand used. It will require at least one full tank of the proper fuel to turn the light off.
See Gasoline Octane on page 6???6.
If none of the above have made the light turn off, your dealer can check the vehicle. The dealer has the proper test equipment and diagnostic tools to fix any mechanical or electrical problems that might have developed.
Emissions Inspection and Maintenance
Programs
Some state/provincial and local governments may have programs to inspect the
The DLC is under the instrument panel to the left of the steering wheel. See your dealer if assistance is needed.
The vehicle may not pass inspection if:
.the Malfunction Indicator Lamp is on with the engine running, or if the light does not come on when the ignition is turned to ON/RUN while the engine is off.
.the critical emission control systems have not been completely diagnosed by the system. This can happen if the battery has recently been replaced or if the battery has run down. The diagnostic system evaluates critical emission control systems during
normal driving. This can take several days of routine driving. If this has been done and the vehicle still does not pass the inspection, your dealer can prepare the vehicle for inspection.
Oil Pressure Light
{ WARNING:
Do not keep driving if the oil pressure is low. The engine can become so hot that it catches fire. Someone could be burned. Check the oil as soon as possible and have the vehicle serviced.
Notice: Lack of proper engine oil maintenance can damage the engine. The repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Always follow the maintenance schedule for changing engine oil.
This light comes on briefly while starting the engine. If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by your dealer.
If the system is working normally the indicator light then goes off.
If the light comes on and stays on, it means that oil is not flowing through the engine properly. The vehicle could be low on oil and it might have some other system problem.
Security Light
For information regarding this light and the vehicle's security system, see
Content
Front Fog Lamp Light
The fog lamp light comes on when the fog lamps are in use.
The light goes out when the fog lamps are turned off. See Fog Lamps on page 4???12 for more information.
Cruise Control Light
The cruise control light comes on whenever the cruise control is set.
The light goes out when the cruise control is turned off. See Cruise Control on page 4??? 7 for more information.
Highbeam On Light
This light comes on when the
See Headlamp
Fuel Gauge
The fuel gauge shows about how much fuel is in the tank.
An arrow on the fuel gauge indicates the side of the vehicle the fuel door is on.
The gauge works only when the ignition is on. When the indicator moves to the edge of the low fuel warning band, the low fuel warning light comes on and a chime sounds. The vehicle still has a little fuel left, but the vehicles fuel tank should be filled soon.
Here are some things that some owners ask about. None of these show a problem with the fuel gauge:
.At the service station, the gas pump shuts off before the gauge reads full.
.It takes more (or less) fuel to fill up than the gauge indicated. For example, the gauge may have indicated half full, but it took more (or less) than half the tank's capacity to fill it.
.The gauge moves up a little while turning a corner, speeding up or making a hard stop.
.The gauge does not go back to empty when the ignition is turned off.
Driver Information Center (DIC)
Your vehicle has a Driver Information Center (DIC).
All messages will appear in the DIC display located below the speedometer in the instrument panel cluster. The DIC buttons are located on the instrument panel, to the left of the instrument panel cluster.
The DIC comes on when the ignition is on. After a short delay, the DIC will display the information that was last displayed before the engine was turned off.
The DIC displays trip, fuel, and vehicle system information, and warning messages if a system problem is detected. The bottom line of the DIC shows the shift lever position indicator. See Automatic Transmission Operation on page 3???22 for more information.
If your vehicle's DIC has these features, the compass direction and the outside air temperature may also display on the DIC when viewing the trip and fuel information. The compass direction appears on the top right corner of the DIC display. The outside air temperature automatically appears in the bottom right corner of the DIC display. If there is a problem with the system that controls the temperature display, the numbers will be replaced with dashes. If this occurs, have the vehicle serviced by your dealer.
The DIC also allows some features to be customized. See DIC Vehicle Customization on page 4???56 for more information.
DIC Operation and Displays
The DIC has different displays which can be accessed by pressing the DIC buttons located on the instrument panel, to the left of the instrument panel cluster.
DIC Buttons
The buttons are the trip/fuel, vehicle information, customization, and set/reset buttons. The button functions are detailed in the following pages.
3 (Trip/Fuel): Press this button to display the odometer, trip odometers, fuel range, average economy, instantaneous economy, and average speed.
T (Vehicle Information): Press this button to display the oil life, units, park assist on vehicles with this feature, side blind zone alert on vehicles with this feature, tire pressure readings on vehicles with this feature, and compass zone and compass calibration on vehicles with this feature.
U (Customization): Press this button to customize the feature settings on your vehicle. See DIC Vehicle Customization on page 4???56 for more information.
V (Set/Reset): Press this button to set or reset certain functions and to turn off or acknowledge messages on the DIC.
Trip/Fuel Menu Items
3 (Trip/Fuel): Press this button to scroll through the following menu items:
Odometer
Press the trip/fuel button until ODOMETER displays. This display shows the distance the vehicle has been driven in either kilometers (km) or miles (mi).
Trip A and Trip B
Press the trip/fuel button until TRIP A or TRIP B displays. This display shows the current distance traveled in either kilometers (km) or miles (mi) since the last reset for each trip odometer. Both trip odometers can be used at the same time.
Each trip odometer can be reset to zero separately by pressing the set/reset button while the desired trip odometer is displayed.
The trip odometer has a feature called the
To use the
moving, the trip odometer will accumulate mileage. For example, if the vehicle was driven 8 km (5 miles) before it is started again, and then the
If the
Fuel Range
Press the trip/fuel button until FUEL RANGE displays. This display shows the approximate number of remaining kilometers (km) or miles (mi) the vehicle can be driven without refueling.
The fuel range estimate is based on an average of the vehicle's fuel economy over recent driving history and the amount of fuel remaining in the fuel tank. This estimate will change if driving conditions change. For example, if driving in traffic and making frequent stops, this display may read one number, but if the vehicle is driven on a freeway, the number may change even though the same amount of fuel is in the fuel tank. This is because different driving conditions produce different fuel economies. Generally, freeway driving produces better fuel economy than city driving.
If your vehicle is low on fuel, the FUEL LEVEL LOW message will be displayed. See ???FUEL LEVEL LOW??? under DIC Warnings and Messages on page 4???47 for more information.
Average Economy
Press the trip/fuel button until AVG ECONOMY displays. This display shows the approximate average liters per 100 kilometers (L/100 km) or miles per gallon (mpg). This number is calculated based on the number of L/100 km (mpg) recorded since the last time this menu item was reset. To reset AVG ECONOMY, press and hold the set/reset button. The display will return to zero.
Instantaneous Economy
Press the trip/fuel button until INST ECONOMY displays. This display shows the current fuel economy at a particular moment and will change frequently as driving conditions change. This display shows the instantaneous fuel economy in liters per 100 kilometers (L/100 km) or miles per gallon (mpg). Unlike average economy, this screen cannot be reset.
Average Speed
Press the trip/fuel button until AVERAGE SPEED displays. This display shows the average speed of the vehicle in kilometers per hour (km/h) or miles per hour (mph). This average is calculated based on the
various vehicle speeds recorded since the last reset of this value. To reset the value, press and hold the set/ reset button. The display will return to zero.
Blank Display
This display shows no information.
Vehicle Information Menu Items
T (Vehicle Information): Press this button to scroll through the following menu items:
Oil Life
Press the vehicle information button until OIL LIFE REMAINING displays. This display shows an estimate of the oil's remaining useful life. If you see 99% OIL LIFE REMAINING on the display, that means 99% of the current oil life remains. The engine oil life system will alert you to change the oil on a schedule consistent with your driving conditions.
When the remaining oil life is low, the CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOON message will appear on the display. See ???CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOON??? under DIC Warnings and Messages on page 4???47. You should change the oil as soon as possible. See Engine Oil on page 6???17. In addition to the engine oil life system monitoring the oil life, additional maintenance is recommended in the Maintenance Schedule in this manual. See Scheduled Maintenance on page 7??? 3 for more information.
Remember, you must reset the OIL LIFE yourself after each oil change. It will not reset itself. Also, be careful not to reset the OIL LIFE accidentally at any time other than when the oil has just been changed. It cannot be reset accurately until the next oil change. To reset the engine oil life system, see Engine Oil Life System on page 6???22.
Units
Press the vehicle information button until UNITS displays. This display allows you to select between Metric or English units of measurement. Once in this display, press the set/reset button to select between ENGLISH or METRIC units.
Park Assist
If your vehicle has the Ultrasonic Rear Parking Assist (URPA) system, this display allows the system to be turned on or off. Press the vehicle information button until PARK ASSIST displays. Once in this display, press the set/reset button to select between ON or OFF. If you choose ON, the system will be turned on. If you choose OFF, the system will be turned off. The URPA system automatically turns back on after each vehicle start. When the URPA system is turned off and the vehicle is shifted out of PARK (P), the DIC will display the PARK ASSIST OFF message as a reminder that the system has been turned off. See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 4???47 and Ultrasonic Rear Parking Assist (URPA) on page 3???33 for more information.
Side Blind Zone
If your vehicle has the Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) system, this display allows the system to be turned on or off. Press the vehicle information button until SIDE BLIND ZONE displays. Once in this display, press the set/reset button to select between ON or OFF. If you choose ON, the system will be turned on. If you choose OFF, the system will be turned off. When the SBZA system is turned off, the DIC will display the SIDE BLIND ZONE ALERT SYSTEM OFF message as a reminder that the system has been turned off. See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 4???47 and Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) on page 3???34 for more information.
Tire Pressure
On vehicles with the Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS), the pressure for each tire can be viewed in the DIC. The tire pressure will be shown in either pounds per square inch (psi) or kilopascals (kPa). Press the vehicle information button until the DIC displays FRONT TIRES PSI (kPa) LEFT ## RIGHT ##. Press the vehicle information button again until the DIC displays REAR TIRES PSI (kPa) LEFT ## RIGHT ##.
If a low tire pressure condition is detected by the system while driving, a message advising you to check the pressure in a specific tire will appear in the display. See Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 6???63 and DIC Warnings and Messages on page 4???47 for more information.
If the tire pressure display shows dashes instead of a value, there may be a problem with your vehicle. If this consistently occurs, see your dealer for service.
Change Compass Zone
Your vehicle may have this feature. To change the compass zone through the DIC, see DIC Compass on page 4???45.
Calibrate Compass
Your vehicle may have this feature. The compass can be manually calibrated. To calibrate the compass through the DIC, see DIC Compass on page 4???45.
Blank Display
This display shows no information.
Customization Menu Items
U (Customization): Press this button to enter the feature settings menu. This display allows you to customize the feature settings on your vehicle. See DIC Vehicle Customization on page 4???56 for more information.
DIC Compass
Your vehicle may have a compass in the Driver Information Center (DIC). The information below explains how to operate this feature in the DIC.
If your vehicle has a compass in the mirror, see
Compass on page 3???29.
Compass Zone
Your dealer will set the correct zone for your location. If the zone is not set to your location or you drive out of the area, the variance needs to be changed to the appropriate zone.
To adjust for compass variance, use the following procedure:
Compass Variance (Zone) Procedure
1.Do not set the compass zone when the vehicle is moving. Only set it when the vehicle is in P (Park).
Press the vehicle information button until PRESS V TO CHANGE COMPASS ZONE displays.
2.Find the vehicle's current location and variance zone number on the map.
Zones 1 through 15 are available.
3.Press the set/reset button to scroll through and select the appropriate variance zone.
4.Press the trip/fuel button until the vehicle heading, for example, N for North, is displayed in the DIC.
5.If calibration is necessary, calibrate the compass. See ???Compass Calibration Procedure??? following.
Compass Calibration
The compass can be manually calibrated. Only calibrate the compass in a magnetically clean and safe location, such as an open parking lot, where driving the vehicle in circles is not a danger. It is suggested to calibrate away from tall buildings, utility wires, manhole covers, or other industrial structures, if possible.
If CAL should ever appear in the DIC display, the compass should be calibrated.
If the DIC display does not show a heading, for example, N for North, or the heading does not change after making turns, there may be a strong magnetic field interfering with the compass. Interference may be caused by a magnetic antenna mount, magnetic note pad holder, or any other magnetic item. Turn off the vehicle, move the magnetic item, then turn on the vehicle and calibrate the compass.
To calibrate the compass, use the following procedure:
Compass Calibration Procedure
1.Before calibrating the compass, check that the compass zone is set to the variance zone in which the vehicle is located. See ???Compass Variance (Zone) Procedure??? earlier in this section.
Do not operate any switches such as window, sunroof, climate controls, seats, etc. during the calibration procedure.
2.Press the vehicle information button until PRESS V TO CALIBRATE COMPASS displays.
3.Press the set/reset button to start the compass calibration.
4.The DIC will display CALIBRATING: DRIVE IN CIRCLES. Drive the vehicle in tight circles at less than 5 mph (8 km/h) to complete the calibration. The DIC will display CALIBRATION COMPLETE for a few seconds when the calibration is complete. The DIC display will then return to PRESS V TO
CALIBRATE COMPASS.
DIC Warnings and Messages
Messages are displayed on the DIC to notify the driver that the status of the vehicle has changed and that some action may be needed by the driver to correct the condition. Multiple messages may appear one after another. Some messages may not require immediate action, but you can press the set/reset button to acknowledge that you received the message and clear it from the DIC display. Pressing any of the DIC buttons also acknowledges and clears any messages. Some messages cannot be cleared from the DIC display because they are more urgent. These messages require action before they can be cleared. You should take any messages that appear on the display seriously and remember that clearing the messages will only make
the messages disappear, not correct the problem. The following are the possible messages that can be displayed and some information about them.
AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL OFF
This message displays when the automatic headlamps are turned off. See Exterior Lamps on page 4???10 for more information.
AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL ON
This message displays when the automatic headlamps are turned on. See Exterior Lamps on page 4???10 for more information.
BATTERY SAVER ACTIVE
This message displays when the system detects that the battery voltage is dropping beyond a reasonable level. The battery saver system starts reducing certain features of the vehicle that you may be able to notice. At the point that the features are disabled, this message is displayed. It means that the vehicle is trying to save the charge in the battery.
Turn off all unnecessary accessories to allow the battery to recharge.
The normal battery voltage range is 11.5 to 15.5 volts.
CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOON
This message displays when service is required for the vehicle. See your dealer. See Engine Oil on page 6???17 and Scheduled Maintenance on page 7??? 3 for more information.
Acknowledging the CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOON message will not reset the OIL LIFE REMAINING. That must be done at the OIL LIFE screen under the vehicle information menu. See ???Oil Life??? under DIC Operation and Displays on page 4???41 and Engine Oil Life System on page 6???22.
DRIVER DOOR OPEN
This message displays when the driver door is not closed properly. Make sure that the door is closed completely.
ENGINE HOT A/C (Air
Conditioning) OFF
This message displays when the engine coolant becomes hotter than the normal operating temperature. To avoid added strain on a hot engine, the air conditioning compressor is automatically turned off. When the coolant temperature returns to normal, the A/C operation automatically resumes. You can continue to drive your vehicle. If this message continues to appear, have the system repaired by your dealer as soon as possible to avoid compressor damage.
ENGINE OVERHEATED IDLE ENGINE
Notice: If you drive your vehicle while the engine is overheating, severe engine damage may occur. If an overheat warning appears on the instrument panel cluster and/or DIC, stop the vehicle as soon as possible. Do not increase the engine speed above normal idling speed. See Engine Overheating on page 6???35 for more information.
This message displays when the engine coolant temperature is too hot. Stop and allow the vehicle to idle until it cools down.
ENGINE OVERHEATED STOP ENGINE
Notice: If you drive your vehicle while the engine is overheating, severe engine damage may occur. If an overheat warning appears on the instrument panel cluster and/or DIC, stop the vehicle as soon as possible. See Engine Overheating on page 6???35 for more information.
This message displays along with a continuous chime when the engine has overheated. Stop and turn the engine off immediately to avoid severe engine damage. See Engine Overheating on page 6???35.
ENGINE POWER IS REDUCED
This message displays when the vehicle's engine power is reduced. Reduced engine power can affect the vehicle's ability to accelerate. If this message is on, but there is no reduction in performance, proceed to your destination. The performance may be reduced the next time the vehicle is driven. The vehicle may be driven at a reduced speed while this message is on, but acceleration and speed may be reduced. Anytime this message stays on, the vehicle should be taken to your dealer for service as soon as possible.
ERROR
This message displays while viewing the odometer or trip odometers if there is a problem with the instrument panel cluster. See your dealer for service.
FUEL LEVEL LOW
This message displays when your vehicle is low on fuel. Refill the fuel tank as soon as possible. See Fuel Gauge on page 4???40 and Filling the Tank on
page 6???10 for more information.
HOOD OPEN
If your vehicle has the remote start feature, this message displays when the hood is not closed properly. Make sure that the hood is closed completely. See
Hood Release on page 6???13.
ICE POSSIBLE DRIVE WITH CARE
This message displays when the outside air temperature is cold enough to create icy road conditions. Adjust your driving accordingly.
LANE DEPARTURE SYSTEM
UNAVAILABLE
If your vehicle has the Lane Departure Warning (LDW) system, this message may display if the LDW system does not activate due to a temporary condition. See
Lane Departure Warning (LDW) on page 3???38 for more
information.
LEFT REAR DOOR OPEN
This message displays when the driver side rear door is not closed properly. Make sure that the door is closed completely.
OIL LEVEL LOW ADD OIL
On some vehicles, this message displays when the vehicle's engine oil is low. Fill the oil to the proper level as soon as possible. See Engine Compartment Overview on page 6???14 for the engine oil fill location. Also, see Engine Oil on page 6???17 for information on the kind of oil to use and the proper oil level.
OIL PRESSURE LOW STOP ENGINE
Notice: If you drive your vehicle while the engine oil pressure is low, severe engine damage may occur. If a low oil pressure warning appears on the instrument panel cluster and/or DIC, stop the vehicle as soon as possible. Do not drive the vehicle until the cause of the low oil pressure is corrected. See Engine Oil on page 6???17 for more information.
This message displays when the vehicle's engine oil pressure is low. The oil pressure light also appears on the instrument panel cluster. See Oil Pressure Light on page 4???38.
Stop the vehicle immediately, as engine damage can result from driving a vehicle with low oil pressure. Have the vehicle serviced by your dealer as soon as possible when this message is displayed.
PARK ASSIST OFF
If your vehicle has this feature, after the vehicle has been started, this message will reminder the driver that the Ultrasonic Rear Parking Assist (URPA) system has been turned off. Press the set/reset button to acknowledge this message and clear it from the DIC display. To turn the URPA system back on, see ???Park Assist??? under DIC Operation and Displays on
page 4???41. See Ultrasonic Rear Parking Assist (URPA) on page 3???33 for more information.
PASSENGER DOOR OPEN
This message displays when the front passenger door is not closed properly. Make sure that the door is closed completely.
REMOTE KEY LEARNING ACTIVE
This message displays while you are matching a Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter to your vehicle. See ???Matching Transmitter(s) to Your Vehicle??? under Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation on page 3??? 4 and DIC Operation and Displays on page 4???41 for more information.
REPLACE BATTERY IN REMOTE KEY
This message displays when the battery in the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter needs to be replaced. To replace the battery, see ???Battery Replacement??? under
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation on page 3??? 4.
RIGHT REAR DOOR OPEN
This message displays when the passenger side rear door is not closed properly. Make sure that the door is closed completely.
SERVICE A/C (Air Conditioning)
SYSTEM
This message displays when the electronic sensors that control the air conditioning and heating systems are no longer working. Have the climate control system serviced by your dealer if you notice a drop in heating and air conditioning efficiency.
SERVICE AIR BAG
This message displays when there is a problem with the airbag system. Have your vehicle serviced by your dealer immediately. See Airbag Readiness Light on page 4???29 for more information.
SERVICE BATTERY CHARGING
SYSTEM
This message displays when there is a problem with the generator and battery charging systems. Driving with this problem could drain the battery. Turn off all unnecessary accessories. Stop and turn off the vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so. Have the electrical system checked by your dealer immediately.
SERVICE BRAKE ASSIST
This message displays if there is a problem with the brake system. The brake system warning light and the antilock brake system warning light may also be displayed on the instrument panel cluster. See Brake
System Warning Light on page 4???32 and Antilock Brake System (ABS) Warning Light on page 4???32 for more information. If this happens, stop as soon as possible and turn off the vehicle. Restart the vehicle and check for the message on the DIC display. If the message is displayed or appears again when you begin driving, the brake system needs service. See your dealer as soon as possible. See Brakes on page 6???39 for more information.
SERVICE BRAKE SYSTEM
This message displays if the ignition is on to inform the driver that the brake fluid level is low. Have the brake system serviced by your dealer as soon as possible. The brake system warning light also appears on the instrument panel cluster when this message appears on the DIC. See Brake System Warning Light on
page 4???31.
SERVICE LANE DEPARTURE SYSTEM
If your vehicle has the Lane Departure Warning (LDW) system, this message may display to indicate that the LDW system is not working properly. If this message remains on after continued driving, the system needs service. See your dealer. See Lane Departure Warning (LDW) on page 3???38 for more information.
SERVICE PARK ASSIST
If your vehicle has this feature, this message displays if there is a problem with the Ultrasonic Rear Parking Assist (URPA) system. Do not use this system to help you park. See Ultrasonic Rear Parking Assist (URPA) on page 3???33 for more information. See your dealer for service.
SERVICE POWER STEERING
Your vehicle may have a speed variable assist steering system. See Steering on page 5???8.
This message displays if a problem is detected with the speed variable assist steering system. When this message is displayed, you may notice that the effort required to steer the vehicle decreases or feels lighter, but you will still be able to steer the vehicle.
SERVICE SIDE BLIND ZONE ALERT
SYSTEM
If your vehicle has the Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) system and this message displays, both SBZA displays will remain on indicating there is a problem with the SBZA system. If these displays remain on after continued driving, the system needs service. See your dealer. See Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) on page 3???34 for more information.
SERVICE STABILITRAK
If your vehicle has StabiliTrak??, this message displays if there has been a problem detected with StabiliTrak.
A warning light also appears on the instrument panel cluster. See Traction Control System (TCS) Warning Light on page 4???33. See StabiliTrak?? System on page 5??? 6 for more information.
If this message turns on while you are driving, pull off the road as soon as possible and stop carefully. Try resetting the system by turning the ignition off and then back on. If this message still stays on or turns back on again while you are driving, your vehicle needs service. Have the StabiliTrak System inspected by your dealer as soon as possible.
SERVICE SUSPENSION SYSTEM
This message displays to indicate that the suspension system is not operating properly. See your dealer for service.
SERVICE THEFT SYSTEM
This message displays when there is a problem with the
The vehicle usually restarts; however, you may want to take the vehicle to your dealer before turning off the engine. See
SERVICE TIRE MONITOR SYSTEM
On vehicles with the Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS), this message displays if a part on the TPMS is not working properly. The tire pressure light also flashes and then remains on during the same ignition cycle. See Tire Pressure Light on page 4???35. Several conditions may cause this message to appear. See Tire Pressure Monitor Operation on page 6???65 for more information. If the warning comes on and stays on, there may be a problem with the TPMS. See your dealer.
SERVICE TRACTION CONTROL
This message displays when the Traction Control System (TCS) is not functioning properly. A warning light also appears on the instrument panel cluster. See Traction Control System (TCS) Warning Light on page 4???33. See Traction Control System (TCS) on page 5??? 6 for more information. Have the TCS serviced by your dealer as soon as possible.
SERVICE TRANSMISSION
This message displays when there is a problem with the transmission. See your dealer for service.
SERVICE VEHICLE SOON
This message displays when a
SIDE BLIND ZONE ALERT
SYSTEM OFF
If your vehicle has the Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) system, this message displays when the SBZA system has been turned off. See Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) on page 3???34 and DIC Operation and Displays on page 4???41 for more information.
SIDE BLIND ZONE SYS. UNAVAILABLE
If your vehicle has the Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) system, this message displays when the SBZA system is disabled because the sensor is blocked and cannot detect vehicles in your blind zone. The sensor may be blocked by mud, dirt, snow, ice, or slush. This message may also display during heavy rain or due to road spray. It may also come on when driving in isolated areas with no guardrails, trees, or road signs and light traffic. Your vehicle does not need service. For cleaning instructions, see Washing Your Vehicle on page 6???100. See Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) on page 3???34 for more information.
SPEED LIMITED TO XXX MPH (km/h)
This message displays when your vehicle speed is limited to 128 km/h (80 mph) because the vehicle detects a problem in the speed variable assist steering, magnetic ride control, or automatic leveling control systems. Have your vehicle serviced by your dealer.
STABILITRAK NOT READY
If your vehicle has StabiliTrak, this message may display and the Traction Control System and StabiliTrak Warning Light on the instrument panel cluster may be on after first driving the vehicle and exceeding 30 km/h (19 mph) for 30 seconds. The StabiliTrak system is not functional until the light has turned off. See StabiliTrak?? System on page 5??? 6 for more information.
STARTING DISABLED SERVICE
THROTTLE
This message displays if the starting of the engine is disabled due to the electronic throttle control system. Have your vehicle serviced by your dealer immediately.
This message only appears while the ignition is in ON/ RUN, and will not disappear until the problem is resolved.
This message cannot be acknowledged.
THEFT ATTEMPTED
This message displays if the content
TIGHTEN GAS CAP
This message may be displayed if the gas cap is not on, or is not fully tightened. Check the gas cap to ensure that it is on properly. See Filling the Tank on page 6???10 for more information.
TIRE LEARNING ACTIVE
On vehicles with the Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS), this message displays when the TPMS is
page 6???63 for more information.
TIRE LOW ADD AIR TO TIRE
On vehicles with the Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS), this message displays when the pressure in one or more of the vehicle's tires is low. This message also displays LEFT FRT (left front), RIGHT FRT (right front), LEFT RR (left rear), or RIGHT RR (right rear) to indicate the location of the low tire. The low tire pressure warning light will also come on. See Tire Pressure Light on page 4???35. If a tire pressure message appears on the DIC, stop as soon as you can. Have the tire pressures checked and set to those shown on the Tire Loading Information label. See Tires on page 6???56, Loading the Vehicle on page 5???18, and Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 6???63. You can receive more than one tire pressure message at a time. To read the other messages that may have been sent at the same time, press the set/reset button. The DIC also shows the tire pressure values. See DIC Operation and Displays on page 4???41.
TRACTION CONTROL OFF
This message displays when the Traction Control System (TCS) is turned off. Adjust your driving accordingly. See Traction Control System (TCS) on page 5??? 6 for more information.
TRACTION CONTROL ON
This message displays when the Traction Control System (TCS) is turned on. See Traction Control System (TCS) on page 5??? 6 for more information.
TRANSMISSION HOT IDLE ENGINE
Notice: If you drive the vehicle while the transmission fluid is overheating and the transmission temperature warning is displayed on the instrument panel cluster and/or DIC, you can damage the transmission. This could lead to costly repairs that would not be covered by the warranty. Do not drive your vehicle with overheated transmission fluid or while the transmission temperature warning is displayed.
This message displays when the transmission fluid in your vehicle is too hot. Stop the vehicle and allow it to idle until it cools down. If the warning message continues to display, have the vehicle serviced by your dealer as soon as possible.
TRUNK OPEN
This message displays when the trunk is not closed completely. Make sure that the trunk is closed completely. See Trunk on page 3???11.
TURN SIGNAL ON
This message displays as a reminder to turn off the turn signal if you drive your vehicle for more than about
1.2 km (0.75 mile) with a turn signal on. See Turn Signal/Multifunction Lever on page 4???4.
This message displays and a chime sounds only when the ignition is in ON/RUN. The message will not disappear until the turn signal is manually turned off, or a turn is completed.
WASHER FLUID LOW ADD FLUID
This message displays when the windshield washer fluid is low. Fill the windshield washer reservoir as soon as possible. See Engine Compartment Overview on page 6???14 for the location of the windshield washer reservoir. Also, see Windshield Washer Fluid on
page 6???38 for more information.
DIC Vehicle Customization
Your vehicle has customization capabilities that allow you to program certain features to one preferred setting. Customization features can only be programmed to one setting on the vehicle and cannot be programmed to a preferred setting for two different drivers.
All of the customization options may not be available on your vehicle. Only the options available will be displayed on the DIC.
The default settings for the customization features were set when your vehicle left the factory, but may have been changed from their default state since then.
The customization preferences are automatically recalled.
To change customization preferences, use the following procedure.
Entering the Feature Settings Menu
1.Turn the ignition on and place the vehicle in P (Park).
To avoid excessive drain on the battery, it is recommended that the headlamps are turned off.
2.Press the customization button to enter the feature settings menu.
If the menu is not available, FEATURE SETTINGS AVAILABLE IN PARK will display. Before entering the menu, make sure the vehicle is in P (Park).
Feature Settings Menu Items
The following are customization features that allow you to program settings to the vehicle:
DISPLAY IN ENGLISH
This feature will only display if a language other than English has been set. This feature allows you to change the language in which the DIC messages appear to English.
Press the customization button until the PRESS V TO DISPLAY IN ENGLISH screen appears on the DIC display. Press the set/reset button once to display all DIC messages in English.
DISPLAY LANGUAGE
This feature allows you to select the language in which the DIC messages will appear.
Press the customization button until the DISPLAY LANGUAGE screen appears on the DIC display. Press the set/reset button once to access the settings for this feature. Then press the customization button to scroll through the following settings:
ENGLISH (default): All messages will appear in English.
FRANCAIS: All messages will appear in French.
ESPANOL: All messages will appear in Spanish.
NO CHANGE: No change will be made to this feature. The current setting will remain.
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desired setting is displayed on the DIC.
AUTO DOOR LOCK
This feature allows you to select when the vehicle's doors will automatically lock. See Programmable Automatic Door Locks on page 3???10 for more information.
Press the customization button until AUTO DOOR LOCK appears on the DIC display. Press the set/reset button once to access the settings for this feature. Then press the customization button to scroll through the following settings:
SHIFT OUT OF PARK (default): The doors automatically lock when the doors are closed and the vehicle is shifted out of P (Park).
AT VEHICLE SPEED: The doors automatically lock when the vehicle speed is above 5 mph (8 km/h) for three seconds.
NO CHANGE: No change will be made to this feature. The current setting will remain.
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desired setting is displayed on the DIC.
AUTO DOOR UNLOCK
This feature allows you to select whether or not to turn off the automatic door unlocking feature. It also allows you to select which doors and when the doors will automatically unlock. See Programmable Automatic Door Locks on page 3???10 for more information.
Press the customization button until AUTO DOOR UNLOCK appears on the DIC display. Press the set/ reset button once to access the settings for this feature. Then press the customization button to scroll through the following settings:
OFF: None of the doors will automatically unlock.
DRIVER AT KEY OUT: Only the driver's door will unlock when the key is taken out of the ignition.
DRIVER IN PARK: Only the driver's door will unlock when the vehicle is shifted into P (Park).
ALL AT KEY OUT: All of the doors will unlock when the key is taken out of the ignition.
ALL IN PARK (default): All of the doors will unlock when the vehicle is shifted into P (Park).
NO CHANGE: No change will be made to this feature. The current setting will remain.
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desired setting is displayed on the DIC.
REMOTE DOOR LOCK
This feature allows you to select the type of feedback you will receive when locking the vehicle with the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter. You will not receive feedback when locking the vehicle with the RKE transmitter if the doors are open. See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation on page 3??? 4 for more information.
Press the customization button until REMOTE DOOR LOCK appears on the DIC display. Press the set/reset button once to access the settings for this feature. Then press the customization button to scroll through the following settings:
HORN & LIGHTS OFF: There will be no feedback when you press the lock button on the RKE transmitter.
LIGHTS ONLY: The exterior lamps will flash when you press the lock button on the RKE transmitter.
HORN ONLY: The horn will sound on the second press of the lock button on the RKE transmitter.
HORN & LIGHTS ON (default): The exterior lamps will flash when you press the lock button on the RKE transmitter, and the horn will sound when the lock button is pressed again within five seconds of the previous command.
NO CHANGE: No change will be made to this feature. The current setting will remain.
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desired setting is displayed on the DIC.
REMOTE DOOR UNLOCK
This feature allows you to select the type of feedback you will receive when unlocking the vehicle with the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter. You will not receive feedback when unlocking the vehicle with the RKE transmitter if the doors are open. See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation on page 3??? 4 for more information.
Press the customization button until REMOTE DOOR UNLOCK appears on the DIC display. Press the set/ reset button once to access the settings for this feature. Then press the customization button to scroll through the following settings:
LIGHTS OFF: The exterior lamps will not flash when you press the unlock button on the RKE transmitter.
LIGHTS ON (default): The exterior lamps will flash when you press the unlock button on the RKE transmitter.
NO CHANGE: No change will be made to this feature. The current setting will remain.
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desired setting is displayed on the DIC.
DELAY DOOR LOCK
This feature allows you to select whether or not the locking of the vehicle's doors will be delayed. When locking the doors with the power door lock switch and a door is open, this feature will delay locking the doors until five seconds after the last door is closed. You will hear three chimes to signal that the delayed locking feature is in use. The key must be out of the ignition for this feature to work. You can temporarily override delayed locking by pressing the power door lock switch twice or the lock button on the RKE transmitter twice. See Delayed Locking on page 3??? 9 for more information.
Press the customization button until DELAY DOOR LOCK appears on the DIC display. Press the set/reset button once to access the settings for this feature. Then press the customization button to scroll through the following settings:
OFF: There will be no delayed locking of the vehicle's doors.
ON (default): The doors will not lock until five seconds after the last door is closed.
NO CHANGE: No change will be made to this feature. The current setting will remain.
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desired setting is displayed on the DIC.
EXIT LIGHTING
This feature allows you to select the amount of time you want the exterior lamps to remain on when it is dark enough outside. This happens after the key is turned from ON/RUN to LOCK/OFF.
Press the customization button until EXIT LIGHTING appears on the DIC display. Press the set/reset button once to access the settings for this feature. Then press the customization button to scroll through the following settings:
OFF: The exterior lamps will not turn on.
30 SECONDS (default): The exterior lamps will stay on for 30 seconds.
1 MINUTE: The exterior lamps will stay on for one minute.
2 MINUTES: The exterior lamps will stay on for two minutes.
NO CHANGE: No change will be made to this feature. The current setting will remain.
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desired setting is displayed on the DIC.
APPROACH LIGHTING
This feature allows you to select whether or not to have the exterior lights turn on briefly during low light periods after unlocking the vehicle using the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter.
Press the customization button until APPROACH LIGHTING appears on the DIC display. Press the set/ reset button once to access the settings for this feature. Then press the customization button to scroll through the following settings:
OFF: The exterior lights will not turn on when you unlock the vehicle with the RKE transmitter.
ON (default): If it is dark enough outside, the exterior lights will turn on briefly when you unlock the vehicle with the RKE transmitter.
The lights will remain on for 20 seconds or until the lock button on the RKE transmitter is pressed, or the vehicle is no longer off. See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
System Operation on page 3??? 4 for more information.
NO CHANGE: No change will be made to this feature. The current setting will remain.
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desired setting is displayed on the DIC.
CHIME VOLUME
This feature allows you to select the volume level of the chime.
Press the customization button until CHIME VOLUME appears on the DIC display. Press the set/reset button once to access the settings for this feature. Then press the customization button to scroll through the following settings:
NORMAL: The chime volume will be set to a normal level.
LOUD: The chime volume will be set to a loud level.
NO CHANGE: No change will be made to this feature. The current setting will remain.
There is no default for chime volume. The volume will stay at the last known setting.
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desired setting is displayed on the DIC.
PARK TILT MIRRORS
If your vehicle has this feature, it allows you to select whether or not the outside mirror(s) will automatically tilt down when the vehicle is shifted into R (Reverse). See
Park Tilt Mirrors on page 3???32 for more information.
Press the customization button until PARK TILT MIRRORS appears on the DIC display. Press the set/ reset button once to access the settings for this feature. Then press the customization button to scroll through the following settings:
OFF (default): Neither outside mirror will be tilted down when the vehicle is shifted into R (Reverse).
DRIVER MIRROR: The driver's outside mirror will be tilted down when the vehicle is shifted into R (Reverse).
PASSENGER MIRROR: The passenger's outside mirror will be tilted down when the vehicle is shifted into R (Reverse).
BOTH MIRRORS: The driver's and passenger's outside mirrors will be tilted down when the vehicle is shifted into R (Reverse).
NO CHANGE: No change will be made to this feature. The current setting will remain.
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desired setting is displayed on the DIC.
EASY EXIT RECALL
If your vehicle has this feature, it allows you to select your preference for the automatic easy exit seat feature. See Memory Seat and Mirrors on page 2??? 7 for more information.
Press the customization button until EASY EXIT RECALL appears on the DIC display. Press the set/ reset button once to access the settings for this feature. Then press the menu up/down button to scroll through the following settings:
DOOR BUTTON ONLY: No automatic seat exit recall will occur. The recall will only occur after pressing the easy exit seat button.
BUTTON AND KEY OUT (default): If the features are enabled through the EASY EXIT SETUP menu, the driver's seat will move back, and if the vehicle has the power tilt wheel and telescopic steering feature, the power steering column will move up and forward when the key is removed from the ignition or after pressing the easy exit seat button. The automatic easy exit seat movement will only occur one time after the key is removed from the ignition. If the automatic movement has already occurred, and you put the key back in the ignition and remove it again, the seat and steering column will stay in the original exit position, unless a memory recall took place prior to removing the key again.
NO CHANGE: No change will be made to this feature. The current setting will remain.
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desired setting is displayed on the DIC.
EASY EXIT SETUP
If your vehicle has this feature, it allows you to select which areas will recall with the automatic easy exit seat feature. It also allows you to turn off the automatic easy exit feature. See Memory Seat and Mirrors on
page 2??? 7 and ???EASY EXIT RECALL??? earlier for more information.
Press the customization button until EASY EXIT SETUP appears on the DIC display. Press the set/reset button once to access the settings for this feature. Then press the menu up/down button to scroll through the following settings:
OFF: No automatic seat exit will recall.
SEAT ONLY: The driver's seat will recall.
TILT ONLY: The steering wheel tilt feature will recall.
TELESCOPE ONLY: The steering column telescope feature will recall.
SEAT/TILT: The driver's seat and the steering wheel tilt feature will recall.
SEAT/TELESCOPE: The driver's seat and the steering column telescope feature will recall.
TILT/TELESCOPE: The steering wheel tilt and steering column telescope features will recall.
ALL (default): The driver's seat and the steering wheel tilt and steering column telescope features will recall,
if your vehicle has this option.
NO CHANGE: No change will be made to this feature. The current setting will remain.
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desired setting is displayed on the DIC.
MEMORY SEAT RECALL
If your vehicle has this feature, it allows you to select your preference for the remote memory seat recall feature. See Memory Seat and Mirrors on page 2??? 7 for more information.
Press the customization button until MEMORY SEAT RECALL appears on the DIC display. Press the set/ reset button once to access the settings for this feature. Then press the customization button to scroll through the following settings:
OFF (default): No remote memory seat recall will occur.
ON: The driver's seat and outside mirrors will automatically move to the stored driving position when the unlock button on the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter is pressed. The steering column will also move on vehicles with the power tilt and telescopic steering feature. See Power Tilt Wheel and Telescopic Steering Column on page 4??? 4 for more information. See ???Relearn Remote Key??? under DIC Operation and Displays on page 4???41 for more information on matching transmitters to driver ID numbers.
NO CHANGE: No change will be made to this feature. The current setting will remain.
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desired setting is displayed on the DIC.
REMOTE START
If the vehicle has remote start, this feature allows it to be turned on or off. When REMOTE START displays, press and hold the reset button, then select ON or OFF. OFF disables the remote start feature. See Remote Vehicle Start on page 3??? 6 for more information.
FACTORY SETTINGS
This feature allows you to set all of the customization features back to their factory default settings.
Press the customization button until FACTORY SETTINGS appears on the DIC display. Press the set/ reset button once to access the settings for this feature. Then press the customization button to scroll through the following settings:
RESTORE ALL (default): The customization features will be set to their factory default settings.
DO NOT RESTORE: The customization features will not be set to their factory default settings.
To select a setting, press the set/reset button while the desired setting is displayed on the DIC.
EXIT FEATURE SETTINGS
This feature allows you to exit the FEATURE SETTINGS menu.
Press the customization button until FEATURE SETTINGS PRESS V TO EXIT appears on the DIC display. Press the set/reset button to exit the menu.
If you do not exit, pressing the customization button again will return you to the beginning of the FEATURE SETTINGS menu.
Exiting the Feature Settings Menu
The feature settings menu will be exited when any of the following occurs:
. The vehicle is shifted out of P (Park).
.The vehicle is no longer in ON/RUN.
.The trip/fuel or vehicle information DIC buttons are pressed.
.The end of the feature settings menu is reached and exited.
.A 40 second time period has elapsed with no selection made.
Audio System(s)
Determine which radio the vehicle has and read the following pages to become familiar with its features.
{ WARNING:
Taking your eyes off the road for extended periods could cause a crash resulting in injury or death to you or others. Do not give extended attention to entertainment tasks while driving.
This system provides access to many audio and non audio listings.
To minimize taking your eyes off the road while driving, do the following while the vehicle is parked:
.Become familiar with the operation and controls of the audio system.
.Set up the tone, speaker adjustments, and preset radio stations.
For more information, see Defensive Driving on page 5??? 2.
Notice: Contact your dealer before adding any equipment.
Adding audio or communication equipment could interfere with the operation of the vehicle's engine, radio, or other systems, and could damage them.
Follow federal rules covering mobile radio and telephone equipment.
The vehicle has Retained Accessory Power (RAP). With RAP, the audio system can be played even after the ignition is turned off. See Retained Accessory Power (RAP) on page 3???19 for more information.
Setting the Clock
To set the time and date:
1.Turn the ignition key to ACC/ACCESSORY or ON/ RUN. Press Oto turn the radio on.
2.Press H and the HR, MIN, MM, DD, YYYY (hour, minute, month, day, and year) displays.
3.Press the softkey located below any one of the tabs that you want to change.
4.To increase the time or date do one of the following:
.Press the softkey located below the selected tab.
.Press ?? SEEK, or \FWD.
.Turn f clockwise.
5.To decrease the time or date do one of the following:
.Press ?? SEEK or sREV.
.Turn f counterclockwise.
The date does not automatically display. To see the date press H while the radio is on. The date with display times out after a few seconds and goes back to the normal radio and time display.
To change the time default setting from 12 hour to 24 hour or to change the date default setting from month/day/year to day/month/year:
1.Press H and then the softkey located below the forward arrow label. Once the time 12H and 24H, and the date MM/DD/YYYY (month, day, and year) and DD/MM/YYYY (day, month, and year) displays.
2.Press the softkey located below the desired option.
3.Press H again to apply the selected default, or let the screen time out.
Radio(s)
Radio with CD (MP3) shown, Radio with CD (MP3) and USB Port similar
The vehicle has one of these radios as its audio system.
Radio Data System (RDS)
The radio may have RDS. The RDS feature is available for use only on FM stations that broadcast RDS information. This system relies upon receiving specific information from these stations and only works when the information is available. While the radio is tuned to an
Playing the Radio
O(Power/Volume): Press to turn the system on and off. Turn to increase or decrease the volume.
Speed Compensated Volume (SCV): Radios with the Speed Compensated Volume (SCV) feature automatically adjust the radio volume to compensate for road and wind noise as the vehicle speeds up or slows down, so that the volume level is consistent.
To activate SCV:
1.Set the radio volume to the desired level.
2.Press the MENU button to display the radio setup menu.
3.Press the softkey under the AUTO VOLUM tab on the radio display.
4.Press the softkey under the desired Speed Compensated Volume setting (OFF, Low, Med, or High) to select the level of radio volume compensation. The display times out after approximately 10 seconds. Each higher setting allows for more radio volume compensation at faster vehicle speeds.
4 (Information): For vehicles with XM, MP3, WMA, or RDS features, press 4 to display additional text information related to the current
or WMA playback. When information is not available, ???No Info??? displays.
Auto Text (Satellite Radio Service, CD, MP3, and WMA features): If additional information is available for the current song being played, Auto Text will automatically page/scroll the information every
three seconds above the FAV presets on the radio display.
To activate Auto Text:
1.Press MENU to display the radio setup menu.
2.Press the softkey under AUTO TXT tab on the radio display.
3.Press the softkey under the ON tab on the radio display.
If 4 is pressed and the song title or artist information is longer than what can be displayed, the extra information will page every three seconds when Auto Text is activated.
Finding a Station
BAND: Press to choose between FM, AM, or XM??? (if equipped).
f (Tune): Turn to select radio stations.
?? SEEK: Press to seek or scan stations with a strong signal in the selected band.
.To seek stations, press and release the ?? SEEK button to go to the previous station and stay there.
.To scan stations, press and hold the ?? SEEK button for a few seconds until the radio beeps once. The radio goes to a station, plays for a few seconds, then goes to the next station. Press the ?? SEEK button again to stop scanning.
.To scan preset stations in the selected band, press and hold the ?? SEEK button for four seconds until a double beep sounds. The radio goes to a stored preset, plays for a few seconds, then goes to the next stored preset. Press the ?? SEEK button again to stop scanning preset stations.
??SEEK: Press to seek or scan stations with a strong signal in the selected band.
.To seek stations, press and release the ?? SEEK button to go to the next station and stay there.
.To scan stations, press and hold the ?? SEEK button for a few seconds until the radio beeps once. The radio goes to a station, plays for a few
seconds, then goes to the next station. Press the ?? SEEK button again to stop scanning.
.To scan preset stations in the selected band, press and hold the ?? SEEK button for four seconds until a double beep sounds. The radio goes to a stored preset, plays for a few seconds, then goes to the next stored preset. Press the ?? SEEK button again to stop scanning preset stations.
Storing a Radio Station
Drivers are encouraged to set up radio station favorites while the vehicle is in P (Park). Tune to favorite stations using the softkeys, favorites button, and steering wheel controls. See Defensive Driving on page 5???2.
FAV (Favorites): A maximum of 36 stations can be stored as favorites using the six softkeys located below the radio station frequency tabs and by using the radio favorites page button (FAV button). Press FAV to go through up to six pages of favorites, each having
six favorite stations available per page. Each page of favorites can contain any combination of AM, FM, or XM stations.
To setup the number of favorites pages:
1.Press the MENU button to display the radio setup menu.
2.Press the softkey located below the FAV
3.Select the desired number of favorites pages by pressing the softkey located below the displayed page numbers.
4.Press the FAV button, or let the menu time out, to return to the original main radio screen showing the radio station frequency tabs and to begin programming favorites.
To store a station as a favorite:
1.Tune to the desired radio station.
2.Press the FAV button to display the page where to store the station.
3.Press and hold one of the six softkeys until a beep sounds.
4.Repeat the steps for each radio station to be stored as a favorite.
Setting the Tone (Bass/Midrange/Treble)
BASS/MID/TREB (Bass, Midrange, or Treble): The radio may display some or all tones such as BASS, MID, and TREB.
To adjust the tone settings:
1.Press the f knob until the tone control tabs display.
2.Press the softkey below the desired tab, then turn the f knob to adjust the highlighted setting. The highlighted setting can also be adjusted by pressing either SEEK arrow, or by pressing the \ FWD or sREV buttons.
The radio may be capable of adjusting bass, midrange, or treble to the middle position by pressing the softkey below the BASS, MID, or TREB tab for more than
two seconds. The radio beeps once and the level adjusts to the middle position.
The radio may also be capable of adjusting all tone and speaker controls to the middle position by pressing the f knob for more than two seconds until the radio beeps once.
If a station's frequency is weak, or has static, decrease the treble.
EQ (Equalization): Press this button to select preset equalization settings.
To return to the manual mode, press the EQ button until Manual displays or start to manually adjust the bass,
midrange, or treble by pressing the f knob.
Adjusting the Speakers (Balance/Fade)
To adjust balance or fade:
1.Press the f knob until the speaker control labels display.
2.Press the softkey under the desired tab,
or continue pressing the f knob to highlight the desired tab.
3.Turn the f knob to adjust the highlighted setting. The highlighted setting can also be adjusted by pressing either SEEK arrow.
On some radios, the \FWD and sREV buttons can also be used to adjust the highlighted level.
The radio may be capable of adjusting balance or fade to the middle position by pressing the softkey below the BAL or FADE tab for more than two seconds. The radio beeps once and the level adjusts to the middle position.
The radio may also be capable of adjusting all tone and speaker controls to the middle position by pressing the f knob for more than two seconds until the radio beeps once.
Finding a Category (CAT) Station
(XM Satellite Radio Service Only)
CAT (Category): To select and find a desired category:
1.Press the BAND button until the XM frequency displays.
2.Press the CAT button to display the category labels on the radio display. Continue pressing the CAT button until the desired category name displays.
3.Press either of the two softkeys below the desired category tab to immediately tune to the first XM station associated with that category.
4.To go to the previous or to the next XM station within the selected category, do one of the following:
. Turn the f knob .
.Press the softkeys below the right or left arrows on the radio display.
. Press either of the ?? SEEK or ?? SEEK buttons.
5.To exit the category search mode, press the FAV button or the BAND button to display the favorites again.
XM categories can be removed through the setup menu. To remove an undesired category:
1.Press the MENU button to display the radio setup menu.
2.Press the softkey below the XM CAT tab.
3.Turn the f knob to display the category to be removed.
4.Press the softkey below the Remove tab until the category name along with the word Removed displays.
5.Repeat the steps to remove additional categories.
Removed categories can be restored by pressing the softkey under the Add tab when a removed category displays or by pressing the softkey below the Restore All tab.
Categories cannot be removed or added while the vehicle is moving faster than 8 km/h (5 mph).
Radio Messages
Calibration Error: Displays if the radio is no longer calibrated properly for the vehicle. The vehicle must be returned to your dealer for service.
Loc or Locked: Displays when the THEFTLOCK?? system has activated. Take the vehicle to your dealer for service.
If any error occurs repeatedly or if an error cannot be corrected, contact your dealer.
XM Satellite Radio Service
XM is a satellite radio service that is based in the 48 contiguous United States and 10 Canadian provinces. XM Satellite Radio has a wide variety of programming and
fee is required to receive the XM service. If XM Service needs to be reactivated, the radio will display "No Subscription Please Renew" on channel XM1. For more information, contact XM at www.xmradio.com or call
Radio Messages for XM Only
See XM Radio Messages on page 4???81 later in this section for further detail.
Loading a CD
Insert a CD partway into the slot, label side up. The player pulls it in and the CD begins playing.
When the CD is inserted, the CD symbol displays. As each new track starts to play, the track number displays.
The CD player can play the smaller 3 inch (8 cm) single CDs with an adapter ring.
Ejecting a CD
ZEJECT: Press to eject the CD. If the CD is not removed, after several seconds, the CD automatically pulls back into the player.
Playing a CD
If the ignition or radio is turned off with a CD in the player, the CD stays in the player. When the ignition or radio is turned on, the CD starts to play where it stopped, if it was the last selected audio source.
f (Tune): Turn to select tracks on the CD currently playing.
?? SEEK: Press to go to the start of the current track, if more than ten seconds have played. Press and hold or press multiple times to continue moving backward through the tracks on the CD.
?? SEEK: Press to go to the next track. Press and hold or press multiple times to continue moving forward through the tracks on the CD.
sREV (Reverse): Press and hold to reverse playback quickly within a track. Sound is heard at a reduced volume and the elapsed time of the track displays. Release to resume playing the track.
\FWD (Fast Forward): Press and hold to advance playback quickly within a track. Sound is heard at a reduced volume and the elapsed time of the track displays. Release to resume playing the track.
RDM (Random): Tracks can be listened to in random, rather than sequential order.
To use random:
1.Press the softkey below RDM tab until Random Current Disc displays.
2.Press the softkey again to turn off random play.
BAND: Press to listen to the radio while a CD is playing. The CD remains inside the radio for future listening.
CD/AUX (CD/Auxiliary): Press to play a CD while listening to the radio. The CD icon and a message showing the track number displays when a CD is in the player. Press this button again and the system automatically searches for an auxiliary input device, such as a portable audio player. If a portable audio player is not connected, No Aux Input Device Found may display.
Playing an MP3
For more information, see Using an MP3 on page 4???75 later in this section.
CD Messages
CHECK DISC: If an error message displays and/or the CD comes out, it could be for one of the following reasons:
.The CD player is very hot. When the temperature returns to normal, the CD should play.
.The road is very rough. When the road becomes smoother, the CD should play.
.The CD is dirty, scratched, wet, or upside down.
.The air is very humid. If so, wait about an hour and try again.
.A problem may have occurred while burning the CD.
.The label could be caught in the CD player.
If the CD is not playing correctly, for any other reason, try a known good CD.
If any error occurs repeatedly or if an error cannot be corrected, contact your dealer. If the radio displays an error message, write it down and provide it to your dealer when reporting the problem.
Care of CDs
Store CD(s) in their original cases or other protective cases and away from direct sunlight and dust. The CD player scans the bottom of the disc. If the bottom of a CD is damaged it may not play properly or at all. Do not touch the bottom of a CD while handling it. Pick up CDs by grasping the outer edges or the edge of the hole and the outer edge.
If the surface of a CD is dirty, take a soft, lint free cloth or dampen a clean, soft cloth in a mild, neutral detergent solution mixed with water, and clean it. Make sure the wiping process starts from the center to
the edge.
Care of the CD Player
Do not add labels to a CD. Labels could get caught ijn the CD player. Use a marking pen to write on the top of the CD if a description is needed.
Do not use CD lens cleaners, they could damage the CD player.
Notice: If a label is added to a CD, or more than one CD is inserted into the slot at a time, or an attempt is made to play scratched or damaged CDs, the CD player could be damaged. While using the CD player, use only CDs in good condition without any label, load one CD at a time, and keep the CD player and the loading slot free of foreign materials, liquids, and debris.
If an error displays, see ???CD Messages??? earlier in this section.
Using the Auxiliary Input Jack
The radio system may have a 3.5 mm (1/8 in) auxiliary input jack located on the faceplate. This is not an audio output; do not plug the headphone set into the front auxiliary input jack. An external audio device such as an iPod??, laptop computer, MP3 player, CD changer, etc. can be connected to the auxiliary input jack for use as another audio source.
Drivers are encouraged to set up any auxiliary device while the vehicle is in P (Park). See Defensive Driving on page 5??? 2 for more information on driver distraction.
To use a portable audio player, connect a 3.5 mm (1/8 in) cable to the radio's front auxiliary input jack. When a device is connected, press the radio CD/AUX button to begin playing audio from the device over the vehicle speakers.
O(Power/Volume): Turn to adjust the volume. Additional volume adjustments may have to be made from the portable device if the volume is too quiet or too loud.
BAND: Press to listen to the radio while a portable audio device is playing. The portable audio device continues playing until it is stopped or turned off.
CD/AUX (CD/Auxiliary): Press to play a CD while a portable audio device is playing. Press again and the system begins playing audio from the connected portable audio player. If a portable audio player is not connected, No Aux Input Device Found may display.
Using the USB Port
Radio's with a USB port can control a USB storage device or an iPod?? using the radio buttons and knobs. See Using an MP3 on page 4???75 for information about how to connect and control a USB storage device or an iPod.
USB Support
The USB connector is located on the front of the radio and uses the USB 2.0 standard.
USB Supported Devices
.USB Flash Drives
.Portable USB Hard Drives
.Fifth generation or later iPod
.First , Second, or Third generation iPod nano
.iPod touch
.iPod classic
Make sure the iPod has the latest firmware from Apple?? for proper operation. iPod firmware can be updated using the latest iTunes?? application. See www.apple.com/itunes.
For help with identifying your iPod, go to
www.apple.com/support.
Using an MP3
Format
Radios that have the capability of playing MP3's can play .mp3 files that were recorded onto a
.mp3 and .wma files that are stored on a USB storage device as well as AAC files that are stored on an iPod??.
Compressed Audio
The radio can play discs that contain both uncompressed CD audio and MP3 files.
The CD player reads all MP3 files first, then the uncompressed CD audio files.
CD???R or CD???RW Supported File and Folder Structure
The radio supports:
.Up to 50 folders.
.Up to 8 folders in depth.
.Up to 50 playlists.
.Up to 255 files.
.Playlists with an .m3u or .wpl extension.
.Files with an .mp3 or .cda file extension.
USB Supported File and Folder Structure
The radio supports:
.Up to 700 folders.
.Up to 8 folders in depth.
.Up to 65,535 files.
.Folder and file names up to 64 bytes.
. Files with an .mp3 or .wma file extension.
.AAC files stored on an iPod.
.FAT16
.FAT32
Root Directory
The root directory is treated as a folder. Files are stored in the root directory when the disc or storage device does not contain folders. Files accessed from the root directory of a CD display as F1 ROOT.
Empty Folder
Folders that do not contain files are skipped, and the player advances to the next folder that contains files.
Order of Play
Tracks are played in the following order:
.Play begins from the first track in the first playlist and continues sequentially through all tracks in each playlist. When the last track of the last playlist has played, play continues from the first track of the first playlist.
.Play begins from the first track in the first folder and continues sequentially through all tracks in each folder. When the last track of the last folder has played, play continues from the first track of the first folder.
When play enters a new folder, the display does not automatically show the new folder name unless the folder mode has been chosen as the default display. The new track name displays.
File System and Naming
The song name that displays is the song name that is contained in the ID3 tag. If the song name is not present in the ID3 tag, then the radio displays the file name without the extension (such as .mp3) as the track name.
Track names longer than 32 characters or four pages are shortened. The display does not show parts of words on the last page of text and the extension of the filename is not displayed.
Preprogrammed Playlists
CDs that have preprogrammed playlists that were created using WinAmp???, MusicMatch???, or Real Jukebox??? software can be accessed, however, there is no playlist editing capability using the radio. These playlists are treated as special folders containing compressed audio song files.
Playlists that have an .m3u or .pls file extension and are stored on a USB device may be supported by the radio with a USB port.
Playing a
f (Tune): Turn to select MP3 files on the CD currently playing.
?? SEEK: Press to go to the start of the track, if more than ten seconds have played. Press and hold or press multiple times to continue moving backward through tracks.
?? SEEK: Press to go to the next track. Press and hold or press multiple times to continue moving forward through tracks.
sREV (Reverse): Press and hold to reverse playback quickly. Sound is heard at a reduced volume and the
elapsed time of the file displays. Release sREV to resume playing.
\FWD (Fast Forward): Press and hold to advance playback quickly. Sound is heard at a reduced volume and the elapsed time of the file displays. Release
\FWD to resume playing. The elapsed time of the file displays.
S c (Previous Folder): Press the softkey below S c to go to the first track in the previous folder.
c T (Next Folder): Press the softkey below c T to go to the first track in the next folder.
RDM (Random): MP3 files can be listened to on a CD in random, rather than sequential order. To use random:
1.Press the softkey under the RDM tab until Random Current Disc displays to play songs from the current CD in random order.
2.Press the same softkey again to turn off random play.
h (Music Navigator): Press the softkey below h to have the files played in order by artist or album. The player scans the disc to sort the files by artist and album ID3 tag information. It can take several minutes to scan the disc depending on the number of files on the disc. The radio may begin playing while it is scanning in the background.
When the scan is finished, the disc begins playing files in order by artist. The current artist playing is shown on the second line of the display. Once all songs by that artist are played, the player moves to the next artist in alphabetical order and begins playing files by that artist.
To listen to files by another artist, press the softkey located below either arrow tab. The disc goes to the next or previous artist in alphabetical order. Continue pressing either softkey below the arrow tab until the desired artist displays.
To change from playback by artist to playback by album:
1.Press the softkey located below the Sort By tab.
2.Press one of the softkeys below the album tab from the sort screen.
3.Press the softkey below the back tab to return to the main music navigator screen.
The album name displays on the second line between the arrows and songs from the current album begins to play. Once all songs from that album have played, the player moves to the next album in alphabetical order on the CD and begins playing MP3 files from that album.
To exit music navigator mode, press the softkey below the Back tab to return to normal MP3 playback.
Connecting a USB Storage Device or iPod??
The USB Port can be used to control an iPod or a USB storage device.
To connect a USB storage device, connect the device to the USB port located on the front of the radio.
To connect an iPod, connect one end of the USB cable that came with the iPod to the iPod???s dock connector and connect the other end to the USB port located on the front of the radio. If the vehicle is on and the USB connection works, ???OK to disconnect??? and a GM logo
may appear on the iPod and iPod appears on the radio's display. The iPod music appears on the radio???s display and begins playing.
The iPod charges while it is connected to the vehicle if the vehicle is in the ACC/ACCESSORY or ON/RUN position. When the vehicle is turned off, the iPod automatically powers off and will not charge or draw power from the vehicle's battery.
If you have an older iPod model that is not supported, it can still be used by connecting it to the Auxiliary Input Jack using a standard 3.5 mm (1/8 in) stereo cable. See ???Using the Auxiliary Input Jack??? earlier for more information.
Using the Radio to Control a USB Storage Device or iPod
The radio can control a USB storage device or an iPod using the radio buttons and knobs and display song information on the radio???s display.
f (Tune): Turn to select files.
?? SEEK: Press to go to the start of the track, if more than ten seconds have played. Press and hold or press multiple times to continue moving backward through tracks.
?? SEEK: Press to go to the next track. Press and hold or press multiple times to continue moving forward through tracks.
sREV (Reverse): Press and hold to reverse playback quickly. Sound is heard at a reduced volume. Release sREV to resume playing. The elapsed time of the file displays.
\FWD (Fast Forward): Press and hold to advance playback quickly. Sound is heard at a reduced volume.
Release \FWD to resume playing. The elapsed time of the file displays.
4 (Information): Press to display additional information about the selected track.
Using Softkeys to Control a USB Storage Device or iPod
The five softkeys below the radio display are used to control the functions listed below.
To use the softkeys:
1.Press the first or fifth softkey below the radio display to display the functions listed below, or press the softkey below the function if it is currently displayed.
2.Press the softkey below the tab with the function on it to use that function.
j(Pause): Press the softkey below jto pause the track. The tab appears raised when pause is being
used. Press the softkey below jagain to resume playback.
Back: Press the softkey below the back tab to go back to the main display screen on an iPod, or the root directory on a USB storage device.
c (Folder View): Press the softkey below c to view the contents of the current folder on the USB drive. To browse and select files:
1.Press the softkey below c.
2.Turn f to scroll through the list of folders.
3.Press f to select the desired folder. If there is more then one folder, repeat Steps 1 and 2 until the desired folder is reached.
4.Turn f to scroll through the files in the selected folder.
5.Press f to select the desired file to be played.
To skip through large lists, the five softkeys can be used to navigate in the following order:
.First softkey, first item in the list.
.Second softkey, 1% through the list each time the softkey is pressed.
.Third softkey, 5% through the list each time the softkey is pressed.
.Fourth softkey, 10% through the list each time the softkey is pressed.
.Fifth softkey, end of the list.
h (Music Navigator): Press the softkey below h to view and select a file on an iPod, using the iPod's menu system. Files are sorted by:
.Playlists
.Artists
.Albums
.Genres
.Songs
. Composers
To select files:
1.Press the softkey below h.
2.Turn f to scroll through the list of menus.
3.Press f to select the desired menu.
4.Turn f to scroll through the folders or files in the selected menu.
5.Press f to select the desired file to be played.
To skip through large lists, the five softkeys can be used to navigate in the following order:
.First softkey, first item in the list.
.Second softkey, 1% through the list each time the softkey is pressed.
.Third softkey, 5% through the list each time the softkey is pressed.
.Fourth softkey, 10% through the list each time the softkey is pressed.
.Fifth softkey, end of the list.
Repeat Functionality
To use Repeat:
Press the softkey below "or 'to select between Repeat All and Repeat Track.
"(Repeat All): Press the softkey below "to repeat all tracks. The tab appears lowered when Repeat All is being used. This is the default mode when a USB storage device or iPod is first connected.
'(Repeat Track): Press the softkey below 'to repeat one track. The tab appears raised when Repeat Track is being used.
Shuffle Functionality
To use Shuffle:
Press the softkey below >, 2, <or =to select between Shuffle Off, Shuffle All Songs/Shuffle Songs, Shuffle Album, or Shuffle Folder.
>(Shuffle Off): Press the softkey below 2to turn shuffle off. This is the default mode when a USB storage device or iPod is first connected.
2(Shuffle All Songs / Shuffle Songs): Press the
softkey below =or <to shuffle all songs on the USB storage device or iPod.
<(Shuffle Album): Press the softkey below >to shuffle all songs in the current album on an iPod.
=(Shuffle Folder): Press the softkey below >to shuffle all songs in the current folder on a USB storage device.
XM Radio Messages
XL (Explicit Language Channels): These channels, or any others, can be blocked at a customer's request, by calling
XM Updating: The encryption code in the receiver is being updated, and no action is required. This process should take no longer than 30 seconds.
No XM Signal: The system is functioning correctly, but the vehicle is in a location that is blocking the XM??? signal. When the vehicle is moved into an open area, the signal should return.
Loading XM: The audio system is acquiring and processing audio and text data. No action is needed. This message should disappear shortly.
Channel Off Air: This channel is not currently in service. Tune in to another channel.
Channel Unauth : This channel is blocked or cannot be received with your XM Subscription package.
Channel Unavail: This previously assigned channel is no longer assigned. Tune to another station. If this station was one of the presets, choose another station for that preset button.
No Artist Info: No artist information is available at this time on this channel. The system is working properly.
No Title Info: No song title information is available at this time on this channel. The system is working properly.
No CAT Info: No category information is available at this time on this channel. The system is working properly.
No Information: No text or informational messages are available at this time on this channel. The system is working properly.
No Subscription Please Renew: XM subscription needs to be reactivated. Contact XM at www.xmradio.com or call
CAT Not Found: There are no channels available for the selected category. The system is working properly.
XM Theftlocked: The XM receiver in the vehicle could have previously been in another vehicle. For security purposes, XM receivers cannot be swapped between vehicles. If this message is received after having the vehicle serviced, check with your dealer.
XM Radio ID: If tuned to channel 0, this message alternates with the XM??? Radio 8 digit radio ID label. This label is needed to activate the service.
Unknown: If this message is received when tuned to channel 0, there could be a receiver fault. Consult with your dealer.
Check Antenna: If this message does not clear within a short period of time, the receiver or antenna could have a fault. Consult with your dealer.
Check XM Receivr: If this message does not clear within a short period of time, the receiver could have a fault. Consult with your dealer.
XM Not Available: If this message does not clear within a short period of time, the receiver could have a fault. Consult with your dealer.
Navigation/Radio System
For vehicles with a navigation radio system, see the separate Navigation System manual.
Bluetooth??
Vehicles with a Bluetooth system can use a Bluetooth capable cell phone with a Hands Free Profile to make and receive phone calls. The system can be used while the key is in ON/RUN or ACC/ACCESSORY position. The range of the Bluetooth system can be up to 9.1 m (30 ft). Not all phones support all functions, and not all phones are guaranteed to work with the
Voice Recognition
The Bluetooth system uses voice recognition to interpret voice commands to dial phone numbers and name tags.
For additional information say ???Help??? while you are in a voice recognition menu.
Noise: Keep interior noise levels to a minimum. The system may not recognize voice commands if there is too much background noise.
When to Speak: A short tone sounds after the system responds indicating when it is waiting for a voice command. Wait until the tone and then speak.
How to Speak: Speak clearly in a calm and natural voice.
Audio System
When using the in???vehicle Bluetooth system, sound comes through the vehicle's front audio system speakers and overrides the audio system. Use the audio system volume knob, during a call, to change the volume level. The adjusted volume level remains in memory for later calls. To prevent missed calls, a minimum volume level is used if the volume is turned down too low.
Bluetooth Controls
Use the buttons located on the steering wheel to operate the in???vehicle Bluetooth system. See Audio Steering Wheel Controls on page 4???90 for more information.
bg (Push To Talk) : Press to answer incoming calls, to confirm system information, and to start speech recognition.
cx (Phone On Hook): Press to end a call, reject a call, or to cancel an operation.
Pairing
A Bluetooth cell phone must be paired to the Bluetooth system and then connected to the vehicle before it can be used. See your cell phone manufacturers user guide for Bluetooth functions before pairing the cell phone. If a Bluetooth phone is not connected, calls will be made using OnStar?? Hands???Free Calling, if available. Refer to the OnStar owner's guide for more information.
Pairing Information
.Up to five cell phones can be paired to the Bluetooth system.
.The pairing process is disabled when the vehicle is moving.
.Pairing only needs to be completed once, unless the pairing information on the cell phone changes or the cell phone is deleted from the system.
.Only one paired cell phone can be connected to the Bluetooth system at a time.
.If multiple paired cell phones are within range of the system, the system connects to the first available paired cell phone in the order that they were first paired to the system. To link to a different paired phone, see ???Linking to a Different Phone??? later in this section.
Pairing a Phone
1.Press and hold bg for two seconds.
2.Say ???Bluetooth???.
3.Say ???Pair???. The system responds with instructions and a four???digit PIN number. The PIN number is used in Step 5.
4.Start the pairing process on the cell phone that you want to pair. For help with this process, see your cell phone manufacturers user guide.
5.Locate the device named ???Your Vehicle??? in the list on the cell phone. Follow the instructions on the cell phone to enter the PIN number that was provided in Step 3. After the PIN number is successfully entered, the system prompts you to provide a name for the paired cell phone. This name will be used to indicate which phones are paired and connected to the vehicle, see ???Listing All Paired and Connected Phones??? later in this section for more information.
6.Repeat Steps 1 through 5 to pair additional phones.
Listing All Paired and Connected Phones
The system can list all cell phones paired to it. If a paired cell phone is also connected to the vehicle, the system responds with ???is connected??? after that
phone name.
1.Press and hold bg for two seconds.
2.Say ???Bluetooth???.
3.Say ???List???.
Deleting a Paired Phone
If the phone name you want to delete is unknown, see ???Listing All Paired and Connected Phones???.
1.Press and hold bg for two seconds.
2.Say ???Bluetooth???.
3.Say ???Delete???. The system asks for which phone to delete.
4.Say the name of the phone you want to delete.
Connecting to a Different Phone
To connect to a different cell phone, the Bluetooth system looks for the next available cell phone in the order in which all the available cell phones were paired. Depending on which cell phone you want to connect to, you may have to use this command several times.
1.Press and hold bg for two seconds.
2.Say ???Bluetooth???.
3.Say ???Change phone???.
. If another cell phone is found, the response will be ???<Phone name> is now connected???.
.If another cell phone is not found, the original phone remains connected.
Storing and Deleting Phone Numbers
The system can store up to 30 phone numbers as name tags in the Hands Free Directory that is shared between the Bluetooth and OnStar systems.
The following commands are used delete and store phone numbers.
Store: This command will store a phone number, or a group of numbers as a name tag.
Digit Store: This command allows a phone number to be stored as a name tag by entering the digits one at a time.
Delete: This command is used to delete individual name tags.
Delete All Name Tags: This command deletes all stored name tags in the Hands Free Calling Directory and the OnStarTurn by Turn Destinations Directory.
Using the ???Store??? Command
1.Press and hold bg for two seconds.
2.Say ???Store???.
3.Say the phone number or group of numbers you want to store all at once with no pauses, then follow the directions given by the system to save a name tag for this number.
Using the ???Digit Store??? Command
If an unwanted number is recognized by the system, say ???Clear??? at any time to clear the last number.
To hear all of the numbers recognized by the system, say ???Verify??? at any time.
1.Press and hold bg for two seconds.
2.Say ???Digit Store???.
3.Say each digit, one at a time, that you want to store. After each digit is entered, the system repeats back the digit it heard followed by a tone. After the last digit has been entered, say ???Store???, and then follow the directions given by the system to save a name tag for this number.
Using the ???Delete??? Command
1.Press and hold bg for two seconds.
2.Say ???Delete???.
3.Say the name tag you want to delete.
Using the ???Delete All Name Tags???
Command
This command deletes all stored name tags in the Hands Free Calling Directory and the OnStarTurn by Turn Destinations Directory.
To delete all name tags:
1.Press and hold bg for two seconds.
2.Say ???Delete all name tags???.
Listing Stored Numbers
The list command will list all the stored numbers and name tags.
Using the ???List??? Command
1.Press and hold bg for two seconds.
2.Say ???Directory???.
3.Say ???Hands Free Calling???.
4.Say ???List???.
Making a Call
Calls can be made using the following commands.
Dial or Call: The dial or call command can be used interchangeably to dial a phone number or a stored name tag.
Digit Dial: This command allows a phone number to be dialed by entering the digits one at a time.
Re???dial : This command is used to dial the last number used on the cell phone.
Using the ???Dial??? or ???Call??? Command
1.Press and hold bg for two seconds.
2.Say ???Dial??? or ???Call???.
3.Say the entire number without pausing or say the name tag.
Once connected, the person called will be heard through the audio speakers.
Using the ???Digit Dial??? Command
The digit dial command allows a phone number to be dialed by entering the digits one at a time. After each digit is entered, the system repeats back the digit it heard followed by a tone.
If an unwanted number is recognized by the system, say ???Clear??? at any time to clear the last number.
To hear all of the numbers recognized by the system, say ???Verify??? at any time.
1.Press and hold bg for two seconds.
2.Say ???Digit Dial???.
3.Say each digit, one at a time, that you want to dial. After each digit is entered, the system repeats back the digit it heard followed by a tone. After the last digit has been entered, say ???Dial???.
Once connected, the person called will be heard through the audio speakers.
Using the ???Re???dial??? Command
1.Press and hold bg for two seconds.
2.After the tone, say ???Re???dial???.
Once connected, the person called will be heard through the audio speakers.
Receiving a Call
When an incoming call is received, the audio system mutes and a ring tone is heard in the vehicle.
.Press bg to answer the call.
.Press cx to ignore a call.
Call Waiting
Call waiting must be supported on the cell phone and enabled by the wireless service carrier.
.Press bg to answer an incoming call when another call is active. The original call is placed on hold.
.Press bg again to return to the original call.
.To ignore the incoming call, no action is required.
.Press cx to disconnect the current call and switch to the call on hold.
Three???Way Calling
Three???way calling must be supported on the cell phone and enabled by the wireless service carrier.
1.While on a call, press bg.
2.Say ???Three???way call???.
3.Use the dial or call command to dial the number of the third party to be called.
4.Once the call is connected, press bg to link all the callers together.
Ending a Call
Press cx to end a call.
Muting a Call
During a call, all sounds from inside the vehicle can be muted so that the person on the other end of the call cannot hear them.
To mute a call, press bg, and then say ???Mute Call???.
To cancel mute, press bg, and then say ???Un???mute Call???.
Transferring a Call
Audio can be transferred between the Bluetooth system and the cell phone.
The cell phone must be paired and connected with the Bluetooth system before a call can be transferred. The connection process can take up to two minutes after the ignition is turned to ON/RUN.
To Transfer Audio From the Bluetooth System to a Cell Phone
During a call with the audio in the vehicle:
1.Press bg.
2.Say ???Transfer Call???.
To Transfer Audio to the Bluetooth System From a Cell Phone
During a call with the audio on the cell phone, press bg. The audio transfers to the vehicle. If the audio does not transfer to the vehicle, use the audio
transfer feature on the cell phone. See your cell phone manufacturers user guide for more information.
Voice
Voice pass???thru allows access to the voice recognition commands on the cell phone. See your cell phone manufacturers user guide to see if the cell phone supports this feature.
To access contacts stored in the cell phone:
1.Press and hold bg for two seconds.
2.Say ???Bluetooth???. The system responds ???Bluetooth ready???, followed by a tone.
3.Say ???Voice???. The system responds ???OK, accessing <phone name>???.
.The cell phone's normal prompt messages will go through its cycle according to the phone's operating instructions.
Dual Tone
Tones
The Bluetooth system can send numbers and the numbers stored as name tags during a call. You can use this feature when calling a menu driven phone system. Account numbers can also be stored for use.
Sending a Number or Name Tag During
aCall
1.Press bg. The system responds ???Ready???, followed by a tone.
2.Say ???Dial???.
3.Say the number or name tag to send.
Clearing the System
Unless information is deleted out of the in???vehicle Bluetooth system, it will be retained indefinitely. This includes all saved name tags in the phone book and phone pairing information. For information on how to delete this information, see the previous sections on Deleting a Paired Phone and Deleting Name Tags.
Other Information
The Bluetooth?? word mark and logos are owned by the Bluetooth?? SIG, Inc. and any use of such marks by General Motors is under license. Other trademarks and trade names are those of their respective owners.
See Radio Frequency Statement on page 8???17 for FCC information.
THEFTLOCK?? is designed to discourage theft of the vehicle's radio by learning a portion of the Vehicle Identification Number (VIN). The radio does not operate if it is stolen or moved to a different vehicle.
Audio Steering Wheel Controls
Vehicles with audio steering wheel controls could differ depending on the vehicle's options. Some audio controls can be adjusted at the steering wheel.
w / x (Next / Previous): Press to select preset or favorite radio stations, select tracks on a CD/DVD, or to navigate an iPod?? or USB device.
Radio
To select preset or favorite radio stations:
Press and release w or x to go to the next or previous radio station stored as a preset or favorite.
CD/DVD
To select tracks on a CD/DVD:
Press and release w or x to go to the next or previous track.
Select tracks on an iPod or USB Device (Vehicles without a Navigation System)
1.Press and hold w or x while listening to a song until the contents of the current folder display on the radio display.
2.Press and release w or x to scroll up or down the list, then press and hold w, or press ?? to play the highlighted track.
Navigating folders on an iPod or USB Device (Vehicles without a Navigation System):
1.Press and hold w or x while listening to a song until the contents of the current folder display on the radio display.
2.Press and hold x to go back to the previous folder list.
3.Press and release w or x to scroll up or down the list.
.To select a folder, press and hold w, or press ?? when the folder is highlighted.
.To go back further in the folder list, press and hold x.
Navigating an iPod or USB Device on the Main Audio Screen (Vehicles with a Navigation System)
Press and release w or x to select the next or previous track within the selected category.
Press and hold w or x to move quickly through the tracks.
Press and release ?? to move up one track within the selected category.
Navigating an iPod or USB Device on the Music Navigator Screen (Vehicles with a Navigation System)
Press and release w or x to select the next or previous track within the selected category.
Press and hold w or x to move quickly through the tracks within the selected category.
Press and release ?? to move up one track within the selected category.
bg (Mute/Push to Talk): Press to silence the vehicle speakers only. Press again to turn the sound on.
For vehicles with Bluetooth or OnStar?? systems, press and hold for longer than two seconds to interact with those systems. See Bluetooth?? on page 4???82 and the OnStar Owner's Guide for more information.
c(End): Press to reject an incoming call, or end a current call.
SRCE (Source/Voice Recognition): Press to switch between the radio, CD, and for vehicles with, DVD, front auxiliary, and rear auxiliary.
For vehicles with the navigation system, press and hold this button for longer than one second to initiate voice recognition. See ???Voice Recognition??? in the Navigation System manual for more information.
?? (Seek): Press to go to the next radio station while in AM, FM, or XM???.
For vehicles with or without a navigation system:
Press ?? to go to the next track or chapter while sourced to the CD or DVD slot.
Press ?? to select a track or a folder when navigating folders on an iPod or USB device.
For vehicles with a navigation system:
1.Press and hold ?? until a beep is heard, to place the radio into SCAN mode, a station will play for
five seconds before moving to the next station.
2.To stop the SCAN function, press ?? again.
While listening to a CD/DVD, press and hold ?? to quickly move forward through the tracks. Release to stop on the desired track.
+ e ??? e (Volume): Press to increase or to decrease the volume.
Radio Reception
Frequency interference and static can occur during normal radio reception if items such as cell phone chargers, vehicle convenience accessories, and external electronic devices are plugged into the accessory power outlet. If there is interference or static, unplug the item from the accessory power outlet.
AM
The range for most AM stations is greater than for FM, especially at night. The longer range can cause station frequencies to interfere with each other. For better radio reception, most AM radio stations boost the power levels during the day, and then reduce these levels
during the night. Static can also occur when things like storms and power lines interfere with radio reception. When this happens, try reducing the treble on the radio.
FM Stereo
FM signals only reach about 10 to 40 miles
(16 to 65 km). Although the radio has a
XM??? Satellite Radio Service
XM Satellite Radio Service gives digital radio reception from
or tunnels may cause loss of the XM signal for a period of time.
Cellular Phone Usage
Cellular phone usage may cause interference with the vehicle's radio. This interference may occur when making or receiving phone calls, charging the phone's battery, or simply having the phone on. This interference causes an increased level of static while listening to the radio. If static is received while listening to the radio, unplug the cellular phone and turn it off.
Backglass Antenna
The
If a cellular telephone antenna needs to be attached to the glass, make sure that the grid lines for the
Notice: Using a razor blade or sharp object to clear the inside rear window can damage the rear window antenna and/or the rear window defogger. Repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Do not clear the inside rear window with sharp objects.
Notice: Do not apply aftermarket glass tinting with metallic film. The metallic film in some tinting materials will interfere with or distort the incoming radio reception. Any damage caused to your backglass antenna due to metallic tinting materials will not be covered by the vehicle warranty.
XM??? Satellite Radio Antenna
System
The XM Satellite Radio antenna is located on the roof of the vehicle. Keep the antenna clear of obstructions for clear radio reception.
If the vehicle has a sunroof, the performance of the XM system may be affected if the sunroof is open.
2 NOTES
Section 5 Driving Your Vehicle
Your Driving, the Road, and the Vehicle . . . . . . . . . .
Defensive Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Drunk Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Control of a Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Braking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Antilock Brake System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Braking in Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
StabiliTrak?? System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Traction Control System (TCS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Magnetic Ride Control??? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Driving at Night . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
or Snow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Your Driving, the Road, and the
Vehicle
Defensive Driving
Defensive driving means ???always expect the unexpected.??? The first step in driving defensively is to wear your safety belt ??? See Safety Belts: They Are for Everyone on page 2???12.
{ WARNING:
Assume that other road users (pedestrians, bicyclists, and other drivers) are going to be careless and make mistakes. Anticipate what they might do and be ready. In addition:
.Allow enough following distance between you and the driver in front of you.
.Focus on the task of driving.
Driver distraction can cause collisions resulting in injury or possible death. These simple defensive driving techniques could save your life.
Drunk Driving
{ WARNING:
Drinking and then driving is very dangerous. Your reflexes, perceptions, attentiveness, and judgment can be affected by even a small amount of alcohol. You can have a serious ??? or even
fatal ??? collision if you drive after drinking. Do not drink and drive or ride with a driver who has been drinking. Ride home in a cab; or if you are with a group, designate a driver who will not drink.
Death and injury associated with drinking and driving is a global tragedy.
Alcohol affects four things that anyone needs to drive a vehicle: judgment, muscular coordination, vision, and attentiveness.
Police records show that almost 40 percent of all motor
250,000 people injured.
For persons under 21, it is against the law in every U.S. state to drink alcohol. There are good medical, psychological, and developmental reasons for these laws.
The obvious way to eliminate the leading highway safety problem is for people never to drink alcohol and then drive.
Medical research shows that alcohol in a person's system can make crash injuries worse, especially injuries to the brain, spinal cord, or heart. This means that when anyone who has been drinking ??? driver or passenger ??? is in a crash, that person's chance of being killed or permanently disabled is higher than if the person had not been drinking.
Control of a Vehicle
The following three systems help to control the vehicle while driving ??? brakes, steering, and accelerator. At times, as when driving on snow or ice, it is easy to ask more of those control systems than the tires and road can provide. Meaning, you can lose control of the vehicle. See Traction Control System (TCS) on
page 5??? 6.
Adding non???dealer accessories can affect vehicle performance. See Accessories and Modifications on page 6??? 3.
Braking
See Brake System Warning Light on page 4???31.
Braking action involves perception time and reaction time. Deciding to push the brake pedal is perception time. Actually doing it is reaction time.
Average reaction time is about three???fourths of a second. But that is only an average. It might be less with one driver and as long as two or three seconds or more with another. Age, physical condition, alertness, coordination, and eyesight all play a part. So do alcohol, drugs, and frustration. But even in three???fourths of a second, a vehicle moving at 100 km/h (60 mph) travels 20 m (66 feet). That could be a lot of distance in an emergency, so keeping enough space between the vehicle and others is important.
And, of course, actual stopping distances vary greatly with the surface of the road, whether it is pavement or gravel; the condition of the road, whether it is wet, dry, or icy; tire tread; the condition of the brakes; the weight of the vehicle; and the amount of brake force applied.
Avoid needless heavy braking. Some people drive in spurts, heavy acceleration followed by heavy braking, rather than keeping pace with traffic. This is a mistake.
The brakes might not have time to cool between hard stops. The brakes will wear out much faster with a lot of heavy braking. Keeping pace with the traffic and allowing realistic following distances eliminates a lot of unnecessary braking. That means better braking and longer brake life.
If the engine ever stops while the vehicle is being driven, brake normally but do not pump the brakes.
If the brakes are pumped, the pedal could get harder to push down. If the engine stops, there will still be some power brake assist but it will be used when the brake is applied. Once the power assist is used up, it can take longer to stop and the brake pedal will be harder
to push.
Adding non???dealer/non???retailer accessories can affect vehicle performance. See Accessories and Modifications on page 6???3.
Antilock Brake System (ABS)
This vehicle has the Antilock Brake System (ABS), an advanced electronic braking system that helps prevent a braking skid.
When the engine is started and the vehicle begins to drive away, ABS checks itself. A momentary motor or clicking noise might be heard while this test is going on, and it might even be noticed that the brake pedal moves a little. This is normal.
If there is a problem with ABS, this warning light stays on. See Antilock Brake System (ABS) Warning Light on
page 4???32.
Let us say the road is wet and you are driving safely. Suddenly, an animal jumps out in front of you. You slam on the brakes and continue braking. Here is what happens with ABS:
A computer senses that the wheels are slowing down. If one of the wheels is about to stop rolling, the computer will separately work the brakes at each front wheel and at both rear wheels.
ABS can change the brake pressure to each wheel, as required, faster than any driver could. This can help the driver steer around the obstacle while braking hard.
As the brakes are applied, the computer keeps receiving updates on wheel speed and controls braking pressure accordingly.
Remember: ABS does not change the time needed to get a foot up to the brake pedal or always decrease stopping distance. If you get too close to the vehicle in front of you, there will not be enough time to apply the brakes if that vehicle suddenly slows or stops. Always leave enough room up ahead to stop, even with ABS.
Using ABS
Do not pump the brakes. Just hold the brake pedal down firmly and let antilock work. The antilock pump or motor operating might be heard and the brake pedal might be felt to pulsate, but this is normal.
Braking in Emergencies
ABS allows the driver to steer and brake at the same time. In many emergencies, steering can help more than even the very best braking.
Brake Assist
This vehicle has a Brake Assist feature designed to assist the driver in stopping or decreasing vehicle speed in emergency driving conditions. This feature uses the stability system hydraulic brake control module to supplement the power brake system under conditions where the driver has quickly and forcefully applied the brake pedal in an attempt to quickly stop or slow down the vehicle. The stability system hydraulic brake control module increases brake pressure at each corner of the vehicle until the ABS activates. Minor brake pedal pulsations or pedal movement during this time is normal and the driver should continue to apply the brake pedal as the driving situation dictates The Brake Assist feature will automatically disengage when the brake pedal is released or brake pedal pressure is quickly decreased.
StabiliTrak?? System
The vehicle has a StabiliTrak system which combines antilock brake, traction and stability control systems and helps the driver maintain directional control of the vehicle in most driving conditions. This is accomplished by selectively applying any one of the vehicle's brakes and reducing engine power.
The StabiliTrak system comes on automatically whenever the vehicle is started. The system cannot be turned off.
This light will flash when the system is operating.
The STABILITRAK NOT READY message may be displayed in the Driver Information Center (DIC) and the Traction Control System (TCS)/StabiliTrak warning light on the instrument panel cluster comes on after first driving the vehicle and exceeding 19 mph (30 km/h) for 30 seconds. The StabiliTrak system is off until the light has turned off. This could take up to 15 minutes.
The TCS/StabiliTrak warning light on the instrument panel cluster will flash when the system is operating. See Traction Control System (TCS) Warning Light on page 4???33 and StabiliTrak?? Indicator Light on
page 4???33 for more information. The system may be heard or felt while it is working. This is normal.
The SERVICE STABILITRAK message is displayed and the TCS/StabiliTrak warning light on the instrument panel cluster comes on if there is a problem with the system. When this light and the SERVICE STABILITRAK message are on, the system is not working. Adjust your driving accordingly.
Traction Control System (TCS)
The vehicle has a Traction Control System (TCS) that limits wheel spin. This is especially useful in slippery road conditions. The system operates only if it senses that the front wheels are spinning too much or beginning to lose traction. When this happens, the system works the front brakes and reduces engine power (by closing the throttle and managing engine spark) to limit wheel spin.
The TCS and StabiliTrak?? light will flash when the system is limiting
wheel spin.
The system may be heard or felt while it is working, but this is normal. See Traction Control System (TCS) Warning Light on page 4???33 for more information.
If the vehicle is in cruise control when TCS begins to limit wheel spin, the cruise control will automatically disengage. The cruise control may be
The SERVICE TRACTION CONTROL message in the DIC and the TCS/StabiliTrak warning light comes on if there is a problem with the traction control system. See
DIC Warnings and Messages on page 4???47.
When this light and the SERVICE TRACTION CONTROL message are on, the system will not limit wheel spin. Adjust your driving accordingly.
To turn the system off or on, press and release this button located in front of the shift lever.
TCS automatically comes on whenever the vehicle is started. To limit wheel spin, especially in slippery road conditions, always leave the system turned on. TCS can be turned off if needed.
The system can be turned on or off at any time by pressing the TCS button. The DIC will display TRACTION CONTROL OFF when the button is pressed, and part of the traction control system is disabled. The vehicle will still have
It is recommended to leave the system on for normal driving conditions, but it may be necessary to turn the system off if the vehicle is stuck in sand, mud, ice or snow, and you want to ???rock??? the vehicle to attempt to free it. See If Your Vehicle is Stuck in Sand, Mud, Ice, or Snow on page 5???17.
Adding non???dealer accessories can affect the vehicle's performance. See Accessories and Modifications on page 6??? 3 for more information.
Magnetic Ride Control???
The vehicle may have Magnetic Ride Control that automatically adjusts the ride of the vehicle. The controller receives input from the system to determine the proper ride. If the controller detects a problem within the system, the Driver Information Center (DIC) displays a SERVICE SUSPENSION SYS message. See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 4???47 for more information. If this message appears, have the vehicle serviced at your dealer.
Steering
Power Steering
If power steering assist is lost because the engine stops or the system is not functioning, the vehicle can be steered but it will take more effort.
Steering Tips
It is important to take curves at a reasonable speed.
Traction in a curve depends on the condition of the tires and the road surface, the angle at which the curve is banked, and vehicle speed. While in a curve, speed is the one factor that can be controlled.
If there is a need to reduce speed, do it before entering the curve, while the front wheels are straight.
Try to adjust the speed so you can drive through the curve. Maintain a reasonable, steady speed. Wait to accelerate until out of the curve, and then accelerate gently into the straightaway.
Steering in Emergencies
There are times when steering can be more effective than braking. For example, you come over a hill and find a truck stopped in your lane, or a car suddenly pulls out from nowhere, or a child darts out from between parked cars and stops right in front of you. These problems can be avoided by braking ??? if you can stop in time. But sometimes you cannot stop in time because there is no room. That is the time for evasive
action ??? steering around the problem.
The vehicle can perform very well in emergencies like these. First apply the brakes. See Braking on
page 5??? 3. It is better to remove as much speed as possible from a collision. Then steer around the problem, to the left or right depending on the space available.
An emergency like this requires close attention and a quick decision. If holding the steering wheel at the recommended 9 and 3 o'clock positions, it can be turned a full 180 degrees very quickly without removing either hand. But you have to act fast, steer quickly, and just as quickly straighten the wheel once you have avoided the object.
The fact that such emergency situations are always possible is a good reason to practice defensive driving at all times and wear safety belts properly.
The vehicle's right wheels can drop off the edge of a road onto the shoulder while driving.
If the level of the shoulder is only slightly below the pavement, recovery should be fairly easy. Ease off the accelerator and then, if there is nothing in the way, steer so that the vehicle straddles the edge of the pavement. Turn the steering wheel 8 to 13 cm (3 to 5 inches), about
Passing
Passing another vehicle on a
.Look down the road, to the sides, and to crossroads for situations that might affect a successful pass. If in doubt, wait.
.Watch for traffic signs, pavement markings, and lines that could indicate a turn or an intersection. Never cross a solid or double???solid line on your side of the lane.
.Do not get too close to the vehicle you want to pass. Doing so can reduce your visibility.
.Wait your turn to pass a slow vehicle.
.When you are being passed, ease to the right.
Loss of Control
Let us review what driving experts say about what happens when the three control systems ??? brakes, steering, and acceleration ??? do not have enough friction where the tires meet the road to do what the driver has asked.
In any emergency, do not give up. Keep trying to steer and constantly seek an escape route or area of less danger.
Skidding
In a skid, a driver can lose control of the vehicle. Defensive drivers avoid most skids by taking reasonable care suited to existing conditions, and by not overdriving those conditions. But skids are always possible.
The three types of skids correspond to the vehicle's three control systems. In the braking skid, the wheels are not rolling. In the steering or cornering skid, too much speed or steering in a curve causes tires to slip and lose cornering force. And in the acceleration skid, too much throttle causes the driving wheels to spin.
Remember: Any traction control system helps avoid only the acceleration skid. If the traction control system is off, then an acceleration skid is best handled by easing your foot off the accelerator pedal.
If the vehicle starts to slide, ease your foot off the accelerator pedal and quickly steer the way you want the vehicle to go. If you start steering quickly enough, the vehicle may straighten out. Always be ready for a second skid if it occurs.
Of course, traction is reduced when water, snow, ice, gravel, or other material is on the road. For safety, slow down and adjust your driving to these conditions. It is important to slow down on slippery surfaces because stopping distance will be longer and vehicle control more limited.
While driving on a surface with reduced traction, try your best to avoid sudden steering, acceleration,
or braking, including reducing vehicle speed by shifting to a lower gear. Any sudden changes could cause the tires to slide. You may not realize the surface is slippery until the vehicle is skidding. Learn to recognize warning clues ??? such as enough water, ice, or packed snow on the road to make a mirrored surface ??? and slow down when you have any doubt.
Remember: Antilock brakes help avoid only the braking skid.
Driving at Night
Night driving is more dangerous than day driving because some drivers are likely to be impaired ??? by alcohol or drugs, with night vision problems, or by fatigue.
Night driving tips include:
.Drive defensively.
.Do not drink and drive.
.Reduce headlamp glare by adjusting the inside rearview mirror.
.Slow down and keep more space between you and other vehicles because headlamps can only light up so much road ahead.
.Watch for animals.
.When tired, pull off the road.
.Do not wear sunglasses.
.Avoid staring directly into approaching headlamps.
.Keep the windshield and all glass on your vehicle clean ??? inside and out.
.Keep your eyes moving, especially during turns or curves.
No one can see as well at night as in the daytime. But, as we get older, these differences increase.
A
Driving in Rain and on Wet Roads
Rain and wet roads can reduce vehicle traction and affect your ability to stop and accelerate. Always drive slower in these types of driving conditions and avoid driving through large puddles and deep???standing or flowing water.
{ WARNING:
Wet brakes can cause crashes. They might not work as well in a quick stop and could cause pulling to one side. You could lose control of the vehicle.
After driving through a large puddle of water or a car/vehicle wash, lightly apply the brake pedal until the brakes work normally.
Flowing or rushing water creates strong forces. Driving through flowing water could cause your vehicle to be carried away. If this happens, you and other vehicle occupants could drown. Do not ignore police warnings and be very cautious about trying to drive through flowing water.
Hydroplaning
Hydroplaning is dangerous. Water can build up under your vehicle's tires so they actually ride on the water. This can happen if the road is wet enough and you are going fast enough. When your vehicle is hydroplaning, it has little or no contact with the road.
There is no hard and fast rule about hydroplaning. The best advice is to slow down when the road is wet.
Other Rainy Weather Tips
Besides slowing down, other wet weather driving tips include:
.Allow extra following distance.
.Pass with caution.
.Keep windshield wiping equipment in good shape.
.Keep the windshield washer fluid reservoir filled.
.Have good tires with proper tread depth. See Tires on page 6???56.
.Turn off cruise control.
Before Leaving on a Long Trip
To prepare your vehicle for a long trip, consider having it serviced by your dealer before departing.
Things to check on your own include:
.Windshield Washer Fluid: Reservoir full? Windows clean ??? inside and outside?
.Wiper Blades: In good shape?
.Fuel, Engine Oil, Other Fluids: All levels checked?
.Lamps: Do they all work and are lenses clean?
.Tires: Are treads good? Are tires inflated to recommended pressure?
.Weather and Maps: Safe to travel? Have
Highway Hypnosis
Always be alert and pay attention to your surroundings while driving. If you become tired or sleepy, find a safe place to park your vehicle and rest.
Other driving tips include:
.Keep the vehicle well ventilated.
.Keep interior temperature cool.
.Keep your eyes moving ??? scan the road ahead and to the sides.
.Check the rearview mirror and vehicle instruments often.
Hill and Mountain Roads
Driving on steep hills or through mountains is different than driving on flat or rolling terrain. Tips for driving in these conditions include:
.Keep the vehicle serviced and in good shape.
.Check all fluid levels and brakes, tires, cooling system, and transmission.
.Going down steep or long hills, shift to a lower gear.
{ WARNING:
If you do not shift down, the brakes could get so hot that they would not work well. You would then have poor braking or even none going down a hill. You could crash. Shift down to let the engine assist the brakes on a steep downhill slope.
{ WARNING:
Coasting downhill in N (Neutral) or with the ignition off is dangerous. The brakes will have to do all the work of slowing down and they could get so hot that they would not work well. You would then have poor braking or even none going down a hill. You could crash. Always have the engine running and the vehicle in gear when going downhill.
.Stay in your own lane. Do not swing wide or cut across the center of the road. Drive at speeds that let you stay in your own lane.
.Top of hills: Be alert ??? something could be in your lane (stalled car, accident).
.Pay attention to special road signs (falling rocks area, winding roads, long grades, passing or
Winter Driving
Driving on Snow or Ice
Drive carefully when there is snow or ice between the tires and the road, creating less traction or grip. Wet ice can occur at about 0??C (32??F) when freezing rain begins to fall, resulting in even less traction. Avoid driving on wet ice or in freezing rain until roads can be treated with salt or sand.
Drive with caution, whatever the condition. Accelerate gently so traction is not lost. Accelerating too quickly causes the wheels to spin and makes the surface under the tires slick, so there is even less traction.
Try not to break the fragile traction. If you accelerate too fast, the drive wheels will spin and polish the surface under the tires even more.
The Traction Control System (TCS) on page 5??? 6 improves the ability to accelerate on slippery roads, but slow down and adjust your driving to the road conditions. When driving through deep snow, turn off the traction control system to help maintain vehicle motion at lower speeds.
The Antilock Brake System (ABS) on page 5??? 4 improves vehicle stability during hard stops on a slippery roads, but apply the brakes sooner than when on dry pavement.
Allow greater following distance on any slippery road and watch for slippery spots. Icy patches can occur on otherwise clear roads in shaded areas. The surface of a curve or an overpass can remain icy when the surrounding roads are clear. Avoid sudden steering maneuvers and braking while on ice.
Turn off cruise control, if equipped, on slippery surfaces.
Blizzard Conditions
Being stuck in snow can be a serious situation. Stay with the vehicle unless there is help nearby. If possible, use the Roadside Assistance Program on page 8??? 7. To get help and keep everyone in the vehicle safe:
.Turn on the Hazard Warning Flashers on page 4??? 3.
.Tie a red cloth to an outside mirror.
{ WARNING:
Snow can trap engine exhaust under the vehicle. This may cause exhaust gases to get inside. Engine exhaust contains carbon monoxide (CO) which cannot be seen or smelled. It can cause unconsciousness and even death.
If the vehicle is stuck in the snow:
.Clear away snow from around the base of your vehicle, especially any that is blocking the exhaust pipe.
.Check again from time to time to be sure snow does not collect there.
(Continued)
WARNING: (Continued)
.Open a window about 5 cm (two inches) on the side of the vehicle that is away from the wind to bring in fresh air.
.Fully open the air outlets on or under the instrument panel.
.Adjust the Climate Control system to a setting that circulates the air inside the vehicle and set the fan speed to the highest setting. See Climate Control System in the Index.
For more information about carbon monoxide, see
Engine Exhaust on page 3???28.
Snow can trap exhaust gases under your vehicle. This can cause deadly CO (carbon monoxide) gas to get inside. CO could overcome you and kill you. You cannot see it or smell it, so you might not know it is in your vehicle. Clear away snow from around the base of your vehicle, especially any that is blocking the exhaust.
Run the engine for short periods only as needed to keep warm, but be careful.
To save fuel, run the engine for only short periods as needed to warm the vehicle and then shut the engine off and close the window most of the way to save heat. Repeat this until help arrives but only when you feel really uncomfortable from the cold. Moving about to keep warm also helps.
If it takes some time for help to arrive, now and then when you run the engine, push the accelerator pedal slightly so the engine runs faster than the idle speed. This keeps the battery charged to restart the vehicle and to signal for help with the headlamps. Do this as little as possible to save fuel.
If Your Vehicle is Stuck in Sand, Mud, Ice, or Snow
Slowly and cautiously spin the wheels to free the vehicle when stuck in sand, mud, ice, or snow. See
Rocking Your Vehicle to Get It Out on page 5???17.
If the vehicle has a traction system, it can often help to free a stuck vehicle. Refer to the vehicle's traction system in the Index. If stuck too severely for the traction system to free the vehicle, turn the traction system off and use the rocking method.
{ WARNING:
If the vehicle's tires spin at high speed, they can explode, and you or others could be injured. The vehicle can overheat, causing an engine compartment fire or other damage. Spin the wheels as little as possible and avoid going above 55 km/h (35 mph) as shown on the speedometer.
For information about using tire chains on the vehicle, see Tire Chains on page 6???77.
Rocking Your Vehicle to Get It Out
Turn the steering wheel left and right to clear the area around the front wheels. Turn off any traction or stability system. Shift back and forth between R (Reverse) and a forward gear, spinning the wheels as little as possible. To prevent transmission wear, wait until the wheels stop spinning before shifting gears. Release the accelerator pedal while shifting, and press lightly on the accelerator pedal when the transmission is in gear. Slowly spinning the wheels in the forward and reverse directions causes a rocking motion that could free the vehicle. If that does not get the vehicle out after a few tries, it might need to be towed out. If the vehicle does need to be towed out, see Towing Your Vehicle on page 5???23.
Loading the Vehicle
It is very important to know how much weight your vehicle can carry. Two labels on your vehicle show how much weight it may properly carry, the Tire and Loading Information label and the Vehicle Certification label.
{ WARNING:
Do not load the vehicle any heavier than the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR),
or either the maximum front or rear Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR). If you do, parts on the vehicle can break, and it can change the way the vehicle handles. These could cause you to lose control and crash. Also, overloading can shorten the life of the vehicle.
Tire and Loading Information Label
Label Example
A vehicle specific Tire and Loading Information label is attached to the vehicle's center pillar
The Tire and Loading Information label also lists the tire size of the original equipment tires (C) and the recommended cold tire inflation pressures (D). For more information on tires and inflation, see
Tires on page 6???56 and Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 6???63.
There is also important loading information on the Certification label. It tells you the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) and the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) for the front and rear axle, see ???Certification Label??? later in this section.
Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit
1.Locate the statement ???The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs??? on your vehicle's placard.
2.Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will be riding in your vehicle.
3.Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX kg or XXX lbs.
4.The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if the ???XXX??? amount equals 1400 lbs and there will be five 150 lb passengers in your vehicle, the amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lbs (1400 ??? 750 (5 x 150) = 650 lbs).
5.Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in Step 4.
6.If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, the load from your trailer will be transferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to determine how this reduces the available cargo and luggage load capacity for your vehicle.
If your vehicle can tow a trailer, see Towing a Trailer on page 5???25 for important information on towing a trailer, towing safety rules, and trailering tips.
Example 1
Example 2
driver, passengers, and cargo should never exceed your vehicle's maximum vehicle capacity weight.
Certification Label
Example 3
Refer to your vehicle's Tire and Loading Information label for specific information about your vehicle's maximum vehicle capacity weight and seating positions. The combined weight of the
A vehicle specific Certification label is found on the rear edge of the driver door.
The label shows the gross weight capacity of your vehicle, called the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR). The GVWR includes the weight of the vehicle, all occupants, fuel, and cargo.
Never exceed the GVWR for your vehicle or the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) for either the front or rear axle.
If there is a heavy load, it should be spread out.
{ WARNING:
Do not load the vehicle any heavier than the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR),
or either the maximum front or rear Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR). If you do, parts on the vehicle can break, and it can change the way the vehicle handles. These could cause you to lose control and crash. Also, overloading can shorten the life of the vehicle.
Notice : Overloading the vehicle may cause damage. Repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Do not overload the vehicle.
If things like suitcases, tools, packages,
or anything else are put inside the vehicle, they will go as fast as the vehicle goes. If you have to stop or turn quickly, or if there is a crash, they will keep going.
{ WARNING:
Things you put inside the vehicle can strike and injure people in a sudden stop or turn, or in a crash.
.Put things in the cargo area of the vehicle. In the cargo area, put them as far forward as you can. Try to spread the weight evenly.
.Never stack heavier things, like suitcases, inside the vehicle so that some of them are above the tops of the seats.
.Do not leave an unsecured child restraint in the vehicle.
.When you carry something inside the vehicle, secure it whenever you can.
.Do not leave a seat folded down unless you need to.
Towing
Towing Your Vehicle
To avoid damage, the disabled vehicle should be towed with all four wheels off the ground. Consult your dealer or a professional towing service if the disabled vehicle must be towed. See Roadside Assistance Program on page 8??? 7.
To tow the vehicle behind another vehicle for recreational purposes, such as behind a motorhome, see ???Recreational Vehicle Towing??? following.
Recreational Vehicle Towing
Recreational vehicle towing means towing the vehicle behind another vehicle ??? such as behind a motorhome. The two most common types of recreational vehicle towing are known as dinghy towing and dolly towing. Dinghy towing is towing the vehicle with all four wheels on the ground. Dolly towing is towing the vehicle with two wheels on the ground and two wheels up on a device known as a dolly.
Here are some important things to consider before recreational vehicle towing:
.What's the towing capacity of the towing vehicle? Be sure to read the tow vehicle manufacturer's recommendations.
.How far will the vehicle be towed? Some vehicles have restrictions on how far and how long they can tow.
.Does the vehicle have the proper towing equipment? See your dealer or trailering professional for additional advice and equipment recommendations.
.Is the vehicle ready to be towed? Just as preparing the vehicle for a long trip, make sure the vehicle is prepared to be towed. See Before Leaving on a Long Trip on page 5???13.
Notice: If the vehicle is towed with all four wheels on the ground, the drivetrain components could be damaged. The repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Do not tow the vehicle with all four wheels on the ground.
The vehicle was not designed to be towed with all four wheels on the ground. Use a dolly if the vehicle must be towed. See ???Dolly Towing??? later in this section for more information.
The vehicle can be towed using a dolly. To tow the vehicle using a dolly, follow these steps:
1.Put the front wheels on a dolly.
2.Put the gear shift lever in P (Park).
3.Set the parking brake.
4.Clamp the steering wheel in a
5.Remove the key from the ignition.
6.Secure the vehicle to the dolly.
7.Release the parking brake.
Towing a Trailer
{ WARNING:
The driver can lose control when pulling a trailer if the correct equipment is not used or the vehicle is not driven properly. For example, if the trailer is too heavy, the brakes may not work well ??? or even at all. The driver and passengers could be seriously injured. The vehicle may also be damaged; the resulting repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Pull a trailer only if all the steps in this section have been followed. Ask your dealer for advice and information about towing a trailer with the vehicle.
Notice: Pulling a trailer improperly can damage the vehicle and result in costly repairs not covered by the vehicle warranty. To pull a trailer correctly, follow the advice in this section and see your dealer for important information about towing a trailer with the vehicle.
The vehicle can tow a trailer if it is equipped with the proper trailer towing equipment. To identify the trailering capacity of the vehicle, read the information in ???Weight of the Trailer??? that appears later in this section. Trailering is different than just driving the vehicle by itself. Trailering means changes in handling, acceleration, braking, durability and fuel economy. Successful, safe trailering takes correct equipment, and it has to be used properly.
The following information has many
Pulling A Trailer
Here are some important points:
.There are many different laws, including speed limit restrictions, having to do with trailering. Make sure the rig will be legal, not only where you live but also where you will be driving. A good source for this information can be state or provincial police.
.Do not tow a trailer at all during the first
1,000 miles (1600 km) the new vehicle is driven. The engine, transmission or other parts could be damaged. The repairs would not be covered by the vehicle's warranty.
.Then, during the first 500 miles (800 km) that a trailer is towed, do not drive over 50 mph (80 km/h) and do not make starts at full throttle. This helps the engine and other parts of the vehicle wear in at the heavier loads.
.Obey speed limit restrictions when towing a trailer. Do not drive faster than the maximum posted speed for trailers, or no more than 55 mph
(90 km/h), to save wear on the vehicle's parts.
.Do not tow a trailer when the outside temperature is above 100??F (38??C).
Three important considerations have to do with weight:
.the weight of the trailer,
.the weight of the trailer tongue
.and the total weight on the vehicle's tires.
Weight of the Trailer
How heavy can a trailer safely be?
It should never weigh more than 1,000 lbs (454 kg). But even that can be too heavy.
It depends on how the rig is used. For example, speed, altitude, road grades, outside temperature and how much the vehicle is used to pull a trailer are all important. It can depend on any special equipment on the vehicle, and the amount of tongue weight the vehicle can carry. See ???Weight of the Trailer Tongue??? later in this section for more information.
Maximum trailer weight is calculated assuming only the driver is in the tow vehicle and it has all the required trailering equipment. The weight of additional optional equipment, passengers and cargo in the tow vehicle must be subtracted from the maximum trailer weight.
Ask your dealer for trailering information or advice, or write us at our Customer Assistance Offices. See
Customer Assistance Offices on page 8??? 5 for more
information.
Weight of the Trailer Tongue
The tongue load (A) of any trailer is an important weight to measure because it affects the total gross weight of the vehicle. The Gross Vehicle Weight (GVW) includes the curb weight of the vehicle, any cargo carried in it, and the people who will be riding in the vehicle. If there are a lot of options, equipment, passengers or cargo in the vehicle, it will reduce the tongue weight the vehicle can carry, which will also reduce the trailer weight the vehicle can tow. If towing a trailer, the tongue load must be added to the GVW because the vehicle will be carrying that weight, too. See Loading the Vehicle on page 5???18 for more information about the vehicle's maximum load capacity.
Using a
After loading the trailer, weigh the trailer and then the tongue, separately, to see if the weights are proper.
If they are not, adjustments might be made by moving some items around in the trailer.
Total Weight on the Vehicle's Tires
Be sure the vehicle's tires are inflated to the upper limit for cold tires. These numbers can be found on the Certification/Tire label. See Loading the Vehicle on page 5???18. Make sure not to go over the GVW limit for the vehicle, including the weight of the trailer tongue.
Hitches
It is important to have the correct hitch equipment. Crosswinds, large trucks going by and rough roads are a few reasons why the right hitch is needed. Here are some rules to follow:
.The rear bumper on the vehicle is not intended for hitches. Do not attach rental hitches or other
.Will any holes be made in the body of the vehicle when the trailer hitch is installed? If there are, then be sure to seal the holes later when the hitch is removed. If the holes are not sealed, dirt, water, and deadly carbon monoxide (CO) from the exhaust can get into the vehicle. See Engine Exhaust on page 3???28 in the Index for more information.
Safety Chains
Always attach chains between the vehicle and the trailer. Cross the safety chains under the tongue of the trailer to help prevent the tongue from contacting the road if it becomes separated from the hitch. Instructions about safety chains may be provided by the hitch manufacturer or by the trailer manufacturer. Follow the manufacturer's recommendation for attaching safety chains and do not attach them to the bumper. Always leave just enough slack so the rig can turn. Never allow safety chains to drag on the ground.
Trailer Brakes
Because the vehicle has antilock brakes, do not try to tap into the vehicle's hydraulic brake system. If you do, both brake systems will not work well, or at all.
Does your trailer have its own brakes? Be sure to read and follow the instructions for the trailer brakes so you will be able to install, adjust and maintain them properly.
Driving with a Trailer
Towing a trailer requires a certain amount of experience. Get to know the rig before setting out for the open road. Get acquainted with the feel of handling and braking with the added weight of the trailer. And always keep in mind that the vehicle you are driving is now longer and not as responsive as the vehicle is by itself.
Before starting, check all trailer hitch parts and attachments, safety chains, electrical connectors, lamps, tires and mirror adjustments. If the trailer has electric brakes, start the vehicle and trailer moving and then apply the trailer brake controller by hand to be sure the brakes are working. This checks the electrical connection at the same time.
During the trip, check occasionally to be sure that the load is secure, and that the lamps and any trailer brakes are still working.
Following Distance
Stay at least twice as far behind the vehicle ahead as you would when driving the vehicle without a trailer. This can help to avoid situations that require heavy braking and sudden turns.
Passing
More passing distance is needed when towing a trailer. Because the rig is longer, it is necessary to go much farther beyond the passed vehicle before returning to the lane.
Backing Up
Hold the bottom of the steering wheel with one hand. Then, to move the trailer to the left, move that hand to the left. To move the trailer to the right, move your hand to the right. Always back up slowly and, if possible, have someone guide you.
Making Turns
Notice: Making very sharp turns while trailering could cause the trailer to come in contact with the vehicle. The vehicle could be damaged. Avoid making very sharp turns while trailering.
When turning with a trailer, make wider turns than normal. Do this so the trailer will not strike soft shoulders, curbs, road signs, trees or other objects. Avoid jerky or sudden maneuvers. Signal well in advance.
Turn Signals When Towing a Trailer
The arrows on the instrument panel flash whenever signaling a turn or lane change. Properly hooked up, the trailer lamps also flash, telling other drivers the vehicle is turning, changing lanes or stopping.
When towing a trailer, the arrows on the instrument panel flash for turns even if the bulbs on the trailer are burned out. For this reason you may think other drivers are seeing the signal when they are not. It is important to check occasionally to be sure the trailer bulbs are still working.
Driving on Grades
Notice: Do not tow on steep continuous grades exceeding 9.6 km (6 miles). Extended, higher than normal engine and transmission temperatures may result and damage the vehicle. Frequent stops are very important to allow the engine and transmission to cool.
Reduce speed and shift to a lower gear before starting down a long or steep downgrade. If the transmission is not shifted down, the brakes might have to be used so much that they would get hot and no longer work well.
On a long uphill grade, shift down and reduce the vehicle's speed to around 45 mph (70 km/h) to reduce the possibility of the engine and the transmission overheating. If the engine does overheat, see Engine Overheating on page 6???35.
Parking on Hills
{ WARNING:
Parking the vehicle on a hill with the trailer attached can be dangerous. If something goes wrong, the rig could start to move. People can be injured, and both the vehicle and the trailer can be damaged. When possible, always park the rig on a flat surface.
If parking the rig on a hill:
1.Press the brake pedal, but do not shift into P (Park) yet. Turn the wheels into the curb if facing downhill or into traffic if facing uphill.
2.Have someone place chocks under the trailer wheels.
3.When the wheel chocks are in place, release the brake pedal until the chocks absorb the load.
4.Reapply the brake pedal. Then apply the parking brake and shift the transmission into P (Park).
5.Release the brake pedal.
Leaving After Parking on a Hill
1.Apply and hold the brake pedal while you:
. start the engine,
. shift into a gear, and
. release the parking brake.
2.Let up on the brake pedal.
3.Drive slowly until the trailer is clear of the chocks.
4.Stop and have someone pick up and store the
chocks.
Maintenance When Trailer Towing
The vehicle needs service more often when pulling a trailer. See Scheduled Maintenance on page 7??? 3 for more information. Things that are especially important in trailer operation are automatic transmission fluid, engine oil, belts, cooling system and brake system. It is a good idea to inspect these before and during the trip.
Check periodically to see that all hitch nuts and bolts are tight.
Engine Cooling When Trailer Towing
The cooling system may temporarily overheat during severe operating conditions. See Engine Overheating on page 6???35.
Changing a Tire When Trailer Towing
If the vehicle gets a flat tire while towing a trailer, be sure to secure the trailer and disconnect it from the vehicle before changing the tire.
2 NOTES
Section 6 Service and Appearance Care
Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Checking Things Under the Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Engine Coolant (3.9L Engine) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Engine Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Overheated Engine Protection
Operating Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power Steering Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Windshield Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Headlamp Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Halogen Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Taillamps, Turn Signal, Stoplamps and
Sidemarker Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Taillamps and
License Plate Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Replacement Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Windshield Wiper Blade Replacement . . . . . . . . . . .
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tire Sidewall Labeling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tire Terminology and Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Inflation - Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tire Pressure Monitor System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tire Pressure Monitor Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tire Inspection and Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Section 6 Service and Appearance Care
When It Is Time for New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Appearance Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Surfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Weatherstrips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
and Trim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Vehicle Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Electrical System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Capacities and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Service
For service and parts needs, visit your dealer. You will receive genuine GM parts and
Genuine GM parts have one of these marks:
Accessories and Modifications
When non???dealer/non???retailer accessories are added to the vehicle, they can affect vehicle performance and safety, including such things as airbags, braking, stability, ride and handling, emissions systems, aerodynamics, durability, and electronic systems like antilock brakes, traction control, and stability control. Some of these accessories could even cause malfunction or damage not covered by the vehicle warranty.
Damage to vehicle components resulting from the installation or use of non???GM certified parts, including control module modifications, is not covered under the terms of the vehicle warranty and may affect remaining warranty coverage for affected parts.
GM Accessories are designed to complement and function with other systems on the vehicle. Your GM dealer can accessorize the vehicle using genuine GM Accessories. When you go to your GM dealer and ask for GM Accessories, you will know that
Also, see Adding Equipment to Your
California Proposition 65 Warning
Most motor vehicles, including this one, contain and/or emit chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm. Engine exhaust, many parts and systems, many fluids, and some component wear
California Perchlorate Materials
Requirements
Certain types of automotive applications, such as airbag initiators, seat belt pretensioners, and lithium batteries contained in remote keyless transmitters, may contain perchlorate materials. Special handling may be necessary. For additional information, see www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate.
Doing Your Own Service Work
{ WARNING:
You can be injured and the vehicle could be damaged if you try to do service work on a vehicle without knowing enough about it.
.Be sure you have sufficient knowledge, experience, the proper replacement parts, and tools before attempting any vehicle maintenance task.
.Be sure to use the proper nuts, bolts, and other fasteners. English and metric fasteners can be easily confused. If the wrong fasteners are used, parts can later break or fall off. You could be hurt.
If doing some of your own service work, use the proper service manual. It tells you much more about how to service the vehicle than this manual can. To order the proper service manual, see Service Publications Ordering Information on page 8???14.
This vehicle has an airbag system. Before attempting to do your own service work, see Servicing Your
Keep a record with all parts receipts and list the mileage and the date of any service work performed. See
Maintenance Record on page 7???12.
Adding Equipment to the Outside of the Vehicle
Things added to the outside of the vehicle can affect the airflow around it. This can cause wind noise and can affect fuel economy and windshield washer performance. Check with your dealer before adding equipment to the outside of the vehicle.
Fuel
Use of the recommended fuel is an important part of the proper maintenance of this vehicle. To help keep the engine clean and maintain optimum vehicle performance, we recommend the use of gasoline advertised as TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline.
Look for the TOP TIER label on the fuel pump to ensure gasoline meets enhanced detergency standards developed by auto companies. A list of marketers providing TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline can be found at www.toptiergas.com.
The 8th digit of the Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) shows the code letter or number that identifies the vehicle's engine. The VIN is at the top left of the instrument panel. See Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) on page 6???105.
Vehicles that have a FlexFuel badge and a yellow fuel cap can use either unleaded gasoline or ethanol fuel containing up to 85% ethanol (E85). See Fuel E85 (85% Ethanol) on page 6??? 8. For all other vehicles, use only the unleaded gasoline described under
Gasoline Octane on page 6???6.
Gasoline Octane
If the vehicle has the 3.9L V6 engine (VIN Code M), use regular unleaded gasoline with a posted octane rating of 87 or higher. If the octane rating is less than 87, an audible knocking noise, commonly referred to as spark knock, might be heard when driving. If this occurs, use a gasoline rated at 87 octane or higher as soon as possible. If heavy knocking is heard when using gasoline rated at 87 octane or higher, the engine needs service.
If the vehicle has the 4.6L V8 engine (VIN Code S), use premium unleaded gasoline with a posted octane rating of 91 or higher. You can also use regular unleaded gasoline rated at 87 octane or higher, but the vehicle's acceleration could be slightly reduced, and a slight audible knocking noise, commonly referred to as spark knock, might be heard. If the octane is less than 87, you might notice a heavy knocking noise when you drive.
If this occurs, use a gasoline rated at 87 octane or higher as soon as possible. Otherwise, you could damage the engine. If heavy knocking is heard when using gasoline rated at 87 octane or higher, the engine needs service.
Gasoline Specifications
At a minimum, gasoline should meet ASTM specification D 4814 in the United States or CAN/ CGSB???3.5 or 3.511 in Canada. Some gasolines contain an
California Fuel
If the vehicle is certified to meet California Emissions Standards, it is designed to operate on fuels that meet California specifications. See the underhood emission control label. If this fuel is not available in states adopting California emissions standards, the vehicle will operate satisfactorily on fuels meeting federal specifications, but emission control system performance might be affected. The malfunction indicator lamp could turn on and the vehicle might fail a smog???check test. See Malfunction Indicator Lamp on page 4???36. If this occurs, return to your authorized dealer for diagnosis.
If it is determined that the condition is caused by the type of fuel used, repairs might not be covered by the vehicle warranty.
Additives
To provide cleaner air, all gasolines in the United States are now required to contain additives that help prevent engine and fuel system deposits from forming, allowing the emission control system to work properly. In most cases, nothing should have to be added to the fuel. However, some gasolines contain only the minimum amount of additive required to meet U.S. Environmental Protection Agency regulations. To help keep fuel injectors and intake valves clean, or if the vehicle experiences problems due to dirty injectors or valves, look for gasoline that is advertised as TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline.
For customers who do not use TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline regularly, one bottle of GM Fuel System Treatment PLUS, added to the fuel tank at every engine oil change, can help clean deposits from fuel injectors and intake valves. GM Fuel System Treatment PLUS is the only gasoline additive recommended by General Motors.
Also, your dealer has additives that will help correct and prevent most deposit???related problems.
Gasolines containing oxygenates, such as ethers and ethanol, and reformulated gasolines might be available in your area. We recommend that you use these gasolines, if they comply with the specifications described earlier. However, E85 (85% ethanol) and other fuels containing more than 10% ethanol must not be used in vehicles that were not designed for those fuels.
Notice: This vehicle was not designed for fuel that contains methanol. Do not use fuel containing methanol. It can corrode metal parts in the fuel system and also damage plastic and rubber parts. That damage would not be covered under the vehicle warranty.
Some gasolines that are not reformulated for low emissions can contain an
Fuel E85 (85% Ethanol)
Vehicles that have a FlexFuel badge and a yellow fuel cap can use either unleaded gasoline or ethanol fuel containing up to 85% ethanol (E85). For all other vehicles, use only the unleaded gasoline described under Gasoline Octane on page 6???6.
We encourage the use of E85 in vehicles that are designed to use it. The ethanol in E85 is a ???renewable??? fuel, meaning it is made from renewable sources such as corn and other crops.
Many service stations will not have an 85% ethanol fuel (E85) pump available. The U.S. Department of Energy has an alternative fuels website (www.eere.energy.gov/ afdc/infrastructure/locator.html) that can help you find E85 fuel. Those stations that do have E85 should have a label indicating ethanol content. Do not use the fuel if the ethanol content is greater than 85%.
At a minimum, E85 should meet ASTM Specification D 5798. By definition, this means that fuel labeled E85 will have an ethanol content between 70% and 85%. Filling the fuel tank with fuel mixtures that do not meet ASTM specifications can affect driveability and could cause the malfunction indicator lamp to come on.
To ensure quick starts in the wintertime, the E85 fuel must be formulated properly for your climate according to ASTM specification D 5798. If you have trouble starting on E85, it could be because the E85 fuel is not properly formulated for your climate. If this happens, switching to gasoline or adding gasoline to the fuel tank can improve starting. For good starting and heater efficiency below 0??C (32??F), the fuel mix in the fuel tank should contain no more than 70% ethanol. It is best not to alternate repeatedly between gasoline and E85.
If you do switch fuels, it is recommended that you add as much fuel as possible ??? do not add less than 11 L (three gallons) when refueling. You should drive the vehicle immediately after refueling for at least 11 km (seven miles) to allow the vehicle to adapt to the change in ethanol concentration.
E85 has less energy per gallon than gasoline, so you will need to refill the fuel tank more often when using E85 than when you are using gasoline. See Filling the Tank on page 6???10.
Notice: Some additives are not compatible with E85 fuel and can harm the vehicle's fuel system. Do not add anything to E85. Damage caused by additives would not be covered by the vehicle warranty.
Notice: This vehicle was not designed for fuel that contains methanol. Do not use fuel containing methanol. It can corrode metal parts in the fuel system and also damage plastic and rubber parts. That damage would not be covered under the vehicle warranty.
Fuels in Foreign Countries
If you plan on driving in another country outside the United States or Canada, the proper fuel might be hard to find. Never use leaded gasoline or any other fuel not recommended in the previous text on fuel. Costly repairs caused by use of improper fuel would not be covered by the vehicle warranty.
To check the fuel availability, ask an auto club,
or contact a major oil company that does business in the country where you will be driving.
Filling the Tank
{ WARNING:
Fuel vapor burns violently and a fuel fire can cause bad injuries. To help avoid injuries to you and others, read and follow all the instructions on the fuel pump island. Turn off the engine when refueling. Do not smoke near fuel or when refueling the vehicle. Do not use cellular phones. Keep sparks, flames, and smoking materials away from fuel. Do not leave the fuel pump unattended when refueling the vehicle. This is against the law in some places. Do not
The tethered fuel cap is located behind a hinged fuel door on the driver side of the vehicle. If the vehicle has E85 fuel capability, the fuel cap will be yellow and state that E85 or gasoline can be used. See Fuel E85 (85% Ethanol) on page 6???8.
To open the fuel door, push the rearward center edge in and release and it will open.
To remove the fuel cap, turn it slowly to the left (counterclockwise). The fuel cap has a spring in it; if the cap is released too soon, it will spring back to the right.
While refueling, hang the tethered fuel cap from the hook on the fuel door.
{ WARNING:
Fuel can spray out on you if you open the fuel cap too quickly. If you spill fuel and then something ignites it, you could be badly burned. This spray can happen if the tank is nearly full, and is more likely in hot weather. Open the fuel cap slowly and wait for any hiss noise to stop. Then unscrew the cap all the way.
Be careful not to spill fuel. Do not top off or overfill the tank and wait a few seconds after you have finished pumping before removing the nozzle. Clean fuel from painted surfaces as soon as possible. See Washing Your Vehicle on page 6???100.
When replacing the fuel cap, turn it to the right (clockwise) until it clicks. Make sure the cap is fully installed. The diagnostic system can determine if the fuel cap has been left off or improperly installed. This would allow fuel to evaporate into the atmosphere. See
Malfunction Indicator Lamp on page 4???36.
The TIGHTEN GAS CAP message displays on the Driver Information Center (DIC) if the fuel cap is not properly installed.
{ WARNING:
If a fire starts while you are refueling, do not remove the nozzle. Shut off the flow of fuel by shutting off the pump or by notifying the station attendant. Leave the area immediately.
Notice: If you need a new fuel cap, be sure to get the right type. Your dealer can get one for you.
If you get the wrong type, it may not fit properly. This may cause the malfunction indicator lamp to light and may damage the fuel tank and emissions system. See Malfunction Indicator Lamp on
page 4???36.
Filling a Portable Fuel Container
{ WARNING:
Never fill a portable fuel container while it is in the vehicle. Static electricity discharge from the container can ignite the fuel vapor. You can be badly burned and the vehicle damaged if this occurs. To help avoid injury to you and others:
.Dispense fuel only into approved containers.
.Do not fill a container while it is inside a vehicle, in a vehicle's trunk, pickup bed, or on any surface other than the ground.
.Bring the fill nozzle in contact with the inside of the fill opening before operating the nozzle. Contact should be maintained until the filling is complete.
.Do not smoke while pumping fuel.
.Do not use a cellular phone while pumping fuel.
Checking Things Under
the Hood
{ WARNING:
An electric fan under the hood can start up and injure you even when the engine is not running. Keep hands, clothing, and tools away from any underhood electric fan.
{ WARNING:
Things that burn can get on hot engine parts and start a fire. These include liquids like fuel, oil, coolant, brake fluid, windshield washer and other fluids, and plastic or rubber. You or others could be burned. Be careful not to drop or spill things that will burn onto a hot engine.
Hood Release
To open the hood:
1.Pull the hood release handle inside the vehicle. It is located next to the parking brake pedal near the floor.
2. Then go to the front of the vehicle and pull the secondary hood release to the right. The hood latch is located under the hood, near the center, at the front edge of the grille.
3. Hold the latch to the right as you lift up on the hood.
Before closing the hood, be sure all the filler caps are on properly. Then just pull the hood down and close it firmly.
Engine Compartment Overview
When you open the hood on the 3.9L V6 engine, here is what you will see:
A.Underhood Fuse Block on page 6???106.
B.Remote Positive (+) Battery Terminal. See Jump Starting on page 6???44.
C.Windshield Washer Fluid Reservoir. See ???Adding Washer Fluid??? under Windshield Washer Fluid on page 6???38.
D.Engine Coolant Recovery Tank. See Cooling System on page 6???27.
E.Radiator Pressure Cap. See Cooling System on page 6???27.
F.Power Steering Fluid Reservoir. See Power Steering Fluid on page 6???37.
G.Engine Oil Fill Cap. See ???When to Add Engine Oil??? under Engine Oil on page 6???17.
H.Engine Oil Dipstick. See ???Checking Engine Oil??? under Engine Oil on page 6???17.
I.Automatic Transmission Fluid Dipstick. See ???Checking the Fluid Level??? under Automatic Transmission Fluid on page 6???24.
J.Brake Fluid Reservoir. See ???Brake Fluid??? under
Brakes on page 6???39.
K.Engine Air Cleaner/Filter on page 6???23.
When you open the hood on the 4.6L V8 engine, here is what you will see:
A.Underhood Fuse Block on page 6???106.
B.Remote Positive (+) Terminal. See Jump Starting on page 6???44.
C.Windshield Washer Fluid Reservoir. See ???Adding Washer Fluid??? under Windshield Washer Fluid on page 6???38.
D.Engine Coolant Surge Tank and Pressure Cap. See Cooling System on page 6???27.
E.Remote Negative (???) Terminal. See Jump Starting on page 6???44.
F. Power Steering Fluid on page 6???37.
G.Engine Oil Fill Cap. See ???When to Add Engine Oil??? under Engine Oil on page 6???17.
H.Engine Oil Dipstick. See ???Checking Engine Oil??? under Engine Oil on page 6???17.
I.Brake Master Cylinder Reservoir. See ???Brake Fluid??? under Brakes on page 6???39.
J.Automatic Transmission Fluid Cap and Dipstick (Out of View). See Automatic Transmission Fluid on page 6???24.
K.Engine Air Cleaner/Filter on page 6???23.
Engine Oil
To ensure proper engine performance and long life, careful attention must be paid to engine oil. Following these simple, but important steps will help protect your investment:
.Always use engine oil approved to the proper specification and of the proper viscosity grade. See ???Selecting the Right Engine Oil.???
.Check the engine oil level regularly and maintain the proper oil level. See ???Checking Engine Oil??? and ???When to Add Engine Oil.???
.Change the engine oil at the appropriate time. See Engine Oil Life System on page 6???22.
.Always dispose of engine oil properly. See ???What to Do With Used Oil.???
Checking Engine Oil
It is a good idea to check the engine oil level at each fuel fill. In order to get an accurate reading, the vehicle must be on level ground. The engine oil dipstick handle is a yellow loop. See Engine Compartment Overview on page 6???14 for the location of the engine oil dipstick.
Obtaining an accurate oil level reading is essential:
1.If the engine has been running recently, turn off the engine and allow several minutes for the oil to drain back into the oil pan. Checking your oil level too soon after engine shut off will not provide an accurate oil level reading.
2.Pull out the dipstick and clean it with a paper towel or cloth, then push it back in all the way. Remove it again, keeping the tip down, and check the level.
When to Add Engine Oil
3.9L V6 Engine
4.6L V8 Engine
If the oil is below the
Notice: Do not add too much oil. Oil levels above or below the acceptable operating range shown on the dipstick are harmful to the engine. If you find that you have an oil level above the operating range, i.e. the engine has so much oil that the oil level gets above the
See Engine Compartment Overview on page 6???14 for the location of the engine oil fill cap.
Add enough oil to put the level somewhere in the proper operating range. Push the dipstick all the way back in when through.
Selecting the Right Engine Oil
Selecting the right engine oil depends on both the proper oil specification and viscosity grade:
Specification
Use and ask for engine oils with the dexos??? certification mark. Oils meeting the requirements of your vehicle should have the dexos??? certification mark on the container. This certification mark indicates that the oil has been approved to the dexos??? specification.
Your vehicle was filled at the factory with dexos??? approved engine oil.
Notice: Use only engine oil that is approved to the dexos??? specification or an equivalent engine oil of the appropriate viscosity grade. Engine oils approved to the dexos??? specification will show the dexos??? symbol on the container. Failure to use the recommended engine oil or equivalent can result in engine damage not covered by the vehicle warranty. If you are unsure whether your oil is approved to the dexos??? specification, ask your service provider.
Use of Substitute Engine Oils if dexos??? is unavailable: In the event that dexos??? approved engine oil is not available at an oil change or for maintaining proper oil level, you may use substitute engine oil displaying the API Starburst symbol and of SAE
Viscosity Grade
SAE
Cold Temperature Operation: In an area of extreme cold, where the temperature falls below ???29??C (???20??F), an SAE
always select an oil that meets the required specification, dexos???. See ???Specification??? for more information.
Engine Oil Additives/Engine Oil Flushes
Do not add anything to the oil. The recommended oils with the dexos??? specification and displaying the dexos??? certification mark are all that is needed for good performance and engine protection.
Engine oil system flushes are not recommended and could cause engine damage not covered by the vehicle warranty.
What to Do with Used Oil
Used engine oil contains certain elements that can be unhealthy for your skin and could even cause cancer. Do not let used oil stay on your skin for very long. Clean your skin and nails with soap and water, or a good hand cleaner. Wash or properly dispose of clothing or rags containing used engine oil. See the manufacturer's warnings about the use and disposal of oil products.
Used oil can be a threat to the environment. If you change your own oil, be sure to drain all the oil from the filter before disposal. Never dispose of oil by putting it in the trash or pouring it on the ground, into sewers,
or into streams or bodies of water. Recycle it by taking it to a place that collects used oil.
Engine Oil Life System
When to Change Engine Oil
This vehicle has a computer system that indicates when to change the engine oil and filter. This is based on engine revolutions and engine temperature, and not on mileage. Based on driving conditions, the mileage at which an oil change is indicated can vary considerably. For the oil life system to work properly, the system must be reset every time the oil is changed.
When the system has calculated that oil life has been diminished, it indicates that an oil change is necessary. A CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOON message comes on. See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 4???47. Change the oil as soon as possible within the next 600 miles (1 000 km). It is possible that, if driving under the best conditions, the oil life system might indicate that an oil change is not necessary for up to a year. The engine oil and filter must be changed at least once a year and, at this time, the system must be reset. Your dealer has trained service people who will perform this work and reset the system. It is also important to check the oil regularly over the course of an oil drain interval and keep it at the proper level.
If the system is ever reset accidentally, the oil must be changed at 3,000 miles (5 000 km) since the last oil change. Remember to reset the oil life system whenever the oil is changed.
How to Reset the Engine Oil Life System
Reset the system whenever the engine oil is changed so that the system can calculate the next engine oil change. Always reset the engine oil life to 100% after every oil change. It will not reset itself. To reset the system:
1.Display the OIL LIFE REMAINING on the DIC.
2.Press and hold the SET/RESET button on the DIC for more than five seconds. The oil life will change to 100%.
If the CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOON message comes back on when the vehicle is started, the engine oil life system has not been reset. Repeat the procedure.
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter
See Engine Compartment Overview on page 6???14 for the location of the engine air cleaner/filter.
When to Inspect the Engine Air Cleaner/ Filter
Inspect the air cleaner/filter at the scheduled maintenance intervals and replace it at the first oil change after each 50,000 mile (80 000 km) interval. See
Scheduled Maintenance on page 7??? 3 for more information. If you are driving in dusty/dirty conditions, inspect the filter at each engine oil change.
How to Inspect the Engine Air Cleaner/ Filter
To inspect the air cleaner/filter, remove the filter from the vehicle and lightly shake the filter to release loose dust and dirt. If the filter remains caked with dirt, a new filter is required.
To inspect or replace the filter:
1.Remove the two screws on the top of the engine air cleaner/filter cover.
2.Lift up the outboard side of the cover at an angle while pulling toward you. This is necessary due to the two hinges located on the inboard side of the cover.
3.Remove the engine air cleaner/filter and any loose debris that may be found in the air cleaner base.
4.Inspect or replace the air filter element.
To reinstall the cover:
1.Align the two hinges located on the inboard side of the cover.
2.Push the cover slightly down and towards the engine to engage the tabs in the hinges and align the two screws.
3.Tighten the two screws on the top of the engine air cleaner/filter cover.
{WARNING:
Operating the engine with the air cleaner/filter off can cause you or others to be burned. The air cleaner not only cleans the air; it helps to stop flames if the engine backfires. Use caution when working on the engine and do not drive with the air cleaner/filter off.
Notice: If the air cleaner/filter is off, dirt can easily get into the engine, which could damage it. Always have the air cleaner/filter in place when you are driving.
Automatic Transmission Fluid
When to Check and Change Automatic Transmission Fluid
A good time to check the automatic transmission fluid level is when the engine oil is changed.
Change the fluid and filter at the intervals listed in
Scheduled Maintenance on page 7??? 3 and be sure to use the transmission fluid listed in Recommended
Fluids and Lubricants on page 7???8.
How to Check Automatic Transmission Fluid (3.9L Engine)
Because this operation can be a little difficult, you may choose to have this done at the dealer service department.
If you do it yourself, be sure to follow all the instructions here, or you could get a false reading on the dipstick.
Notice: Too much or too little fluid can damage the transmission. Too much can mean that some of the fluid could come out and fall on hot engine parts or exhaust system parts, starting a fire. Too little fluid could cause the transmission to overheat. Be sure to get an accurate reading if checking the transmission fluid.
Wait at least 30 minutes before checking the transmission fluid level if you have been driving:
.When outside temperatures are above 90??F (32??C).
.At high speed for quite a while.
.In heavy traffic ??? especially in hot weather.
.While pulling a trailer.
To get the right reading, the fluid should be at normal operating temperature, which is 180??F to 200??F (82??C to 93??C).
Get the vehicle warmed up by driving about 15 miles (24 km) when outside temperatures are above 50??F (10??C). If it is colder than 50??F (10??C), you may have to drive longer.
Checking the Fluid Level
Prepare the vehicle as follows:
1.Park the vehicle on a level place. Keep the engine running.
2.With the parking brake applied, place the shift lever in P (Park).
3.With your foot on the brake pedal, move the shift lever through each gear range, pausing for about three seconds in each range. Then, position the shift lever in P (Park).
4.Let the engine run at idle for three to five minutes.
Then, without shutting off the engine, follow these steps:
1. For the 3.9L V6 engine, locate the transmission fluid dipstick top which is a round loop with this symbol.
See Engine Compartment Overview on page 6???14 for more information on location.
2.Pull out the dipstick and wipe it with a clean rag or paper towel.
3.Push it back in all the way, wait three seconds, and then pull it back out again.
3.9L V6 Engine
4.Check both sides of the dipstick and read the lower level. The fluid level must be in the
5.If the fluid level is in the acceptable range, push the dipstick back in all the way.
How to Add Automatic Transmission Fluid
Refer to the Maintenance Schedule to determine what kind of transmission fluid to use. See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 7???8.
If the fluid level is low, add only enough of the proper fluid to bring the level into the
1.Pull out the dipstick.
2.Using a
It does not take much fluid, generally less than one pint (0.5 L). Do not overfill.
Notice: Use of the incorrect automatic transmission fluid may damage the vehicle, and the damages may not be covered by the vehicle's warranty. Always use the automatic transmission fluid listed in
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 7???8.
3.After adding fluid, recheck the fluid level as described under ???How to Check Automatic Transmission Fluid??? earlier in this section.
4.When the correct fluid level is obtained, push the dipstick back in all the way.
How to Check Automatic Transmission Fluid (4.6L Engine)
For the 4.6L V8 engine, it is not necessary to check the transmission fluid level. A transmission fluid leak is the only reason for fluid loss. If a leak occurs, take the vehicle to your dealer service department and have it repaired as soon as possible.
Cooling System
The cooling system allows the engine to maintain the correct working temperature.
3.9L Engine
A.Coolant Recovery Tank
B.Radiator Pressure Cap
C.Electric Engine Cooling Fans
4.6L Engine
A.Coolant Surge Tank with Pressure Cap
B.Electric Engine Cooling Fans
{ WARNING:
An electric engine cooling fan under the hood can start up even when the engine is not running and can cause injury. Keep hands, clothing, and tools away from any underhood electric fan.
{ WARNING:
Heater and radiator hoses, and other engine parts, can be very hot. Do not touch them. If you do, you can be burned.
Do not run the engine if there is a leak. If you run the engine, it could lose all coolant. That could cause an engine fire, and you could be burned. Get any leak fixed before you drive the vehicle.
Notice: Using coolant other than
Engine Coolant (4.6L Engine)
The cooling system in the vehicle is filled with
The following explains the cooling system and how to check and add coolant when it is low. If there is a problem with engine overheating, see Engine Overheating on page 6???35.
What to Use
{ WARNING:
Adding only plain water or some other liquid to the cooling system can be dangerous. Plain water and other liquids, can boil before the proper coolant mixture will. The vehicle's coolant warning system is set for the proper coolant mixture. With plain water or the wrong mixture, the engine could get too hot but you would not get the overheat warning. The engine could catch fire and you or others could be burned. Use a 50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable water and
Use a 50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable water and
.Gives freezing protection down to ???34??F (???37??C), outside temperature.
.Gives boiling protection up to 265??F (129??C), engine temperature.
.Protects against rust and corrosion.
.Will not damage aluminum parts.
.Helps keep the proper engine temperature.
Notice: If an improper coolant mixture is used, the engine could overheat and be badly damaged. The repair cost would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Too much water in the mixture can freeze and crack the engine, radiator, heater core, and other parts.
Notice: If extra inhibitors and/or additives are used in the vehicle's cooling system, the vehicle could be damaged. Use only the proper mixture of the engine coolant listed in this manual for the cooling system. See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on
page 7??? 8 for more information.
Checking Coolant
The vehicle must be on a level surface when checking the coolant level.
Check to see if coolant is visible in the coolant recovery tank. If the coolant inside the coolant recovery tank is boiling, do not do anything else until it cools down.
If coolant is visible but the coolant level is not at or above the FULL COLD mark, add a 50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable water and
If no coolant is visible in the surge tank, add coolant as follows:
How to Add Coolant to the Surge Tank
{ WARNING:
You can be burned if you spill coolant on hot engine parts. Coolant contains ethylene glycol and it will burn if the engine parts are hot enough. Do not spill coolant on a hot engine.
Notice: This vehicle has a specific coolant fill procedure. Failure to follow this procedure could cause the engine to overheat and be severely damaged.
{ WARNING:
An electric engine cooling fan under the hood can start up even when the engine is not running and can cause injury. Keep hands, clothing, and tools away from any underhood electric fan.
{ WARNING:
Steam and scalding liquids from a hot cooling system can blow out and burn you badly. They are under pressure, and if you turn the surge tank pressure cap ??? even a little ??? they can come out at high speed. Never turn the cap when the cooling system, including the surge tank pressure cap, is hot. Wait for the cooling system and surge tank pressure cap to cool if you ever have to turn the pressure cap.
You can remove the coolant surge tank pressure cap when the cooling system, including the coolant surge tank pressure cap and upper radiator hose, is no longer hot.
1.Turn the pressure cap slowly counterclockwise. If you hear a hiss, wait for that to stop. A hiss means there is still some pressure left.
2.Then keep turning the cap and remove it.
3.Fill the coolant surge tank with the proper mixture to the FULL COLD mark on the side of the coolant
surge tank.
4.With the coolant surge tank cap off, start the engine and let it run until you can feel the upper radiator hose getting hot. Watch out for the engine cooling fans.
By this time, the coolant level inside the coolant surge tank may be lower. If the level is lower, add more of the proper mixture to the coolant surge tank until the level reaches the FULL COLD mark on the side of the coolant surge tank.
5.Then replace the cap. Be sure the cap is hand???tight and fully seated.
If coolant is needed, add the proper
Notice: If the pressure cap is not tightly installed, coolant loss and possible engine damage may occur. Be sure the cap is properly and tightly secured.
Engine Coolant (3.9L Engine)
The cooling system in the vehicle is filled with
The following explains the cooling system and how to check and add coolant when it is low. If there is a problem with engine overheating, see Engine Overheating on page 6???35.
What to Use
{ WARNING:
Adding only plain water or some other liquid to the cooling system can be dangerous. Plain water and other liquids, can boil before the proper coolant mixture will. The vehicle's coolant warning system is set for the proper coolant mixture. With plain water or the wrong mixture, the engine could get too hot but you would not get the overheat warning. The engine could catch fire and you or others could be burned. Use a 50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable water and
Use a 50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable water and
.Gives freezing protection down to ???34??F (???37??C), outside temperature.
.Gives boiling protection up to 265??F (129??C), engine temperature.
.Protects against rust and corrosion.
.Will not damage aluminum parts.
.Helps keep the proper engine temperature.
Notice: If an improper coolant mixture is used, the engine could overheat and be badly damaged. The repair cost would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Too much water in the mixture can freeze and crack the engine, radiator, heater core, and other parts.
Notice: If extra inhibitors and/or additives are used in the vehicle's cooling system, the vehicle could be damaged. Use only the proper mixture of the engine coolant listed in this manual for the cooling system. See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on
page 7??? 8 for more information.
Checking Coolant
The vehicle must be on a level surface when checking the coolant level.
The coolant level should be at or above the FULL COLD mark when the engine is cold. The coolant level should be above the FULL COLD mark under normal operating conditions. If it is not, you may have a leak in the cooling system.
Check to see if coolant is visible in the coolant recovery tank. If the coolant inside the coolant recovery tank is boiling, do not do anything else until it cools down.
If coolant is visible but the coolant level is not at or above the FULL COLD mark, add a 50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable water and
How to Add Coolant to the
Recovery Tank
{ WARNING:
You can be burned if you spill coolant on hot engine parts. Coolant contains ethylene glycol and it will burn if the engine parts are hot enough. Do not spill coolant on a hot engine.
Notice: This vehicle has a specific coolant fill procedure. Failure to follow this procedure could cause the engine to overheat and be severely damaged.
If coolant is needed, add the proper
How to Add Coolant to the Radiator
{ WARNING:
An electric engine cooling fan under the hood can start up even when the engine is not running and can cause injury. Keep hands, clothing, and tools away from any underhood electric fan.
{ WARNING:
Steam and scalding liquids from a hot cooling system can blow out and burn you badly. They are under pressure, and if you turn the surge tank pressure cap ??? even a little ??? they can come out at high speed. Never turn the cap when the cooling system, including the surge tank pressure cap, is hot. Wait for the cooling system and surge tank pressure cap to cool if you ever have to turn the pressure cap.
If coolant is needed, add the proper mixture directly to the radiator, but be sure the cooling system is cool before this is done.
1. You can remove the pressure cap when the cooling system, including the pressure cap and upper radiator hose is no longer
hot. Turn the pressure cap slowly counterclockwise.
2.If you hear a hiss, wait for that to stop. A hiss means that there is still some pressure left. Keep turning the pressure cap and remove it.
3.Fill the cooling system with the proper
4.Then fill the coolant recovery tank to the COLD FILL line.
5.Install the coolant recovery tank cap and the pressure cap. After a day or two of driving, when the engine is cold, check the coolant level in the recovery tank. If it is low, refill it to the COLD FILL line.
If the coolant in the recovery tank is constantly low, you should have a dealer service department inspect the vehicle for leaks.
Notice: If the pressure cap is not tightly installed, coolant loss and possible engine damage may occur. Be sure the cap is properly and tightly secured.
Engine Overheating
The vehicle has several indicators to warn of engine overheating.
You will find a warning light about a hot engine as well as an engine coolant temperature gauge on the instrument panel cluster.
You may decide not to lift the hood when this warning appears, but instead get service help right away. See
Roadside Assistance Program on page 8???7.
If you do decide to lift the hood, make sure the vehicle is parked on a level surface.
Then check to see if the engine cooling fans are running. If the engine is overheating, both fans should be running. If they are not, do not continue to run the engine and have the vehicle serviced.
Notice: Engine damage from running the engine without coolant is not covered by the warranty.
Notice: If the engine catches fire while driving with no coolant, the vehicle can be badly damaged. The costly repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. See Overheated Engine Protection Operating Mode on page 6???37 for information on driving to a safe place in an emergency.
If Steam Is Coming From The Engine
Compartment
{ WARNING:
Steam from an overheated engine can burn you badly, even if you just open the hood. Stay away from the engine if you see or hear steam coming from it. Turn it off and get everyone away from the vehicle until it cools down. Wait until there is no sign of steam or coolant before you open
the hood.
If you keep driving when the vehicles engine is overheated, the liquids in it can catch fire. You or others could be badly burned. Stop the engine if it overheats, and get out of the vehicle until the engine is cool.
See Overheated Engine Protection Operating Mode on page 6???37 for information on driving to a safe place in an emergency.
If No Steam Is Coming From The
Engine Compartment
If an engine overheat warning is displayed but no steam can be seen or heard, the problem may not be too serious. Sometimes the engine can get a little too hot when the vehicle:
.Climbs a long hill on a hot day.
.Stops after
.Idles for long periods in traffic.
.Tows a trailer.
If the overheat warning is displayed with no sign of steam:
1.Turn the air conditioning off.
2.Turn the heater on to the highest temperature and to the highest fan speed. Open the windows as necessary.
3.In heavy traffic, let the engine idle in N (Neutral) while stopped. If it is safe to do so, pull off the road, shift to P (Park) or N (Neutral) and let the engine idle.
If the temperature overheat gauge is no longer in the overheat zone or an overheat warning no longer displays, the vehicle can be driven. Continue to drive the vehicle slow for about 10 minutes. Keep a safe
vehicle distance from the car in front of you. If the warning does not come back on, continue to drive normally.
If the warning continues, pull over, stop, and park the vehicle right away.
If there is no sign of steam, idle the engine for three minutes while parked. If the warning is still
displayed, turn off the engine until it cools down. Also, see ???Overheated Engine Protection Operating Mode??? next in this section.
Overheated Engine Protection
Operating Mode
If an overheated engine condition exists and the message ENGINE OVERHEATED STOP ENGINE is displayed, an overheat protection mode which alternates firing groups of cylinders helps prevent engine damage. In this mode, you will notice a loss in power and engine performance. This operating mode allows the vehicle to be driven to a safe place in an emergency. Driving extended miles (km) and/or towing a trailer in the overheat protection mode should be avoided.
Notice: After driving in the overheated engine protection operating mode, to avoid engine damage, allow the engine to cool before attempting any repair. The engine oil will be severely degraded. Repair the cause of coolant loss, change the oil and reset the oil life system. See Engine Oil on
page 6???17.
Power Steering Fluid
See Engine Compartment
Overview on page 6???14
for information on the location of the power steering fluid reservoir.
When to Check Power Steering Fluid
It is not necessary to regularly check power steering fluid unless you suspect there is a leak in the system or you hear an unusual noise. A fluid loss in this system could indicate a problem. Have the system inspected and repaired.
How to Check Power Steering Fluid
To check the power steering fluid:
1.Turn the key off and let the engine compartment cool down.
2.Wipe the cap and the top of the reservoir clean.
3.Unscrew the cap and wipe the dipstick with a clean rag.
4.Replace the cap and completely tighten it.
5.Remove the cap again and look at the fluid level on the dipstick.
The level should be at the FULL COLD mark.
If necessary, add only enough fluid to bring the level up to the mark.
What to Use
To determine what kind of fluid to use, see
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 7??? 8.
Always use the proper fluid.
Notice: Use of the incorrect fluid may damage the vehicle and the damages may not be covered by the vehicle's warranty. Always use the correct fluid listed in Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on
page 7??? 8.
Windshield Washer Fluid
What to Use
When the vehicle needs windshield washer fluid, be sure to read the manufacturer's instructions before use. If the vehicle will be operating in an area where the temperature may fall below freezing, use a fluid that has sufficient protection against freezing.
Adding Washer Fluid
Open the cap with the washer symbol on it. Add washer fluid until the tank is full. See Engine Compartment Overview on page 6???14 for reservoir location.
Notice:
.When using concentrated washer fluid, follow the manufacturer's instructions for adding water.
.Do not mix water with
.Fill the washer fluid tank only
.Do not use engine coolant (antifreeze) in the windshield washer. It can damage the windshield washer system and paint.
Brakes
Brake Fluid
The brake master cylinder reservoir is filled with DOT 3 brake fluid. See Engine Compartment Overview on page 6???14 for the location of the reservoir.
There are only two reasons why the brake fluid level in the reservoir might go down:
.The brake fluid level goes down because of normal brake lining wear. When new linings are installed, the fluid level goes back up.
.A fluid leak in the brake hydraulic system can also cause a low fluid level. Have the brake hydraulic system fixed, since a leak means that sooner or later the brakes will not work well.
Do not top off the brake fluid. Adding fluid does not correct a leak. If fluid is added when the linings are worn, there will be too much fluid when new brake linings are installed. Add or remove brake fluid, as necessary, only when work is done on the brake hydraulic system.
{ WARNING:
If too much brake fluid is added, it can spill on the engine and burn, if the engine is hot enough. You or others could be burned, and the vehicle could be damaged. Add brake fluid only when work is done on the brake hydraulic system.
When the brake fluid falls to a low level, the brake warning light comes on. See Brake System Warning Light on page 4???31.
What to Add
Use only new DOT 3 brake fluid from a sealed container. See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 7??? 8.
Always clean the brake fluid reservoir cap and the area around the cap before removing it. This helps keep dirt from entering the reservoir.
{ WARNING:
With the wrong kind of fluid in the brake hydraulic system, the brakes might not work well. This could cause a crash. Always use the proper brake fluid.
Notice:
.Using the wrong fluid can badly damage brake hydraulic system parts. For example, just a few drops of
.If brake fluid is spilled on the vehicle's painted surfaces, the paint finish can be damaged. Be careful not to spill brake fluid on the vehicle. If you do, wash it off immediately. See Washing Your Vehicle on page 6???100.
Brake Wear
This vehicle has disc brakes. Disc brake pads have
{ WARNING:
The brake wear warning sound means that soon the brakes will not work well. That could lead to a crash. When the brake wear warning sound is heard, have the vehicle serviced.
Notice: Continuing to drive with
Some driving conditions or climates can cause a brake squeal when the brakes are first applied or lightly applied. This does not mean something is wrong with the brakes.
Properly torqued wheel nuts are necessary to help prevent brake pulsation. When tires are rotated, inspect brake pads for wear and evenly tighten wheel nuts in the proper sequence to torque specifications in
Capacities and Specifications on page 6???114.
Brake linings should always be replaced as complete axle sets.
Brake Pedal Travel
See your dealer if the brake pedal does not return to normal height, or if there is a rapid increase in pedal travel. This could be a sign that brake service might be required.
Brake Adjustment
Every time the brakes are applied, with or without the vehicle moving, the brakes adjust for wear.
Replacing Brake System Parts
The braking system on a vehicle is complex. Its many parts have to be of top quality and work well together if the vehicle is to have really good braking. The vehicle was designed and tested with
When parts of the braking system are replaced ??? for example, when the brake linings wear down and new ones are installed ??? be sure to get new approved replacement parts. If this is not done, the brakes might not work properly. For example, if someone puts in brake linings that are wrong for the vehicle, the balance between the front and rear brakes can change ??? for the worse. The braking performance expected can change in many other ways if the wrong replacement brake parts are installed.
Battery
Refer to the replacement number on the original battery label when a new battery is needed.
{ DANGER:
Battery posts, terminals, and related accessories contain lead and lead compounds, chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and reproductive harm. Wash hands after handling.
The battery is under the rear seat cushion. To access the battery, see ???Removing the Rear Seat Cushion??? under Rear Underseat Fuse Block on page 6???109. Access to the battery is not necessary to jump start the vehicle. See Jump Starting on page 6???44.
{ WARNING:
A battery that is not properly vented can let sulfuric acid fumes into the area under the rear seat cushion. These fumes can damage the rear seat safety belt systems. You might not be able to see this damage and the safety belts might not provide the protection needed in a crash. If a replacement battery is ever needed, it must be vented in the same manner as the original battery. Always make sure that the vent hose is properly reattached before reinstalling the seat cushion.
To be sure the vent hose (A) is properly attached, the vent hose connectors (B) must be securely reattached to the vent outlets (C) on each side of the battery and the vent assembly grommet (D) must be secured to the floor pan (E).
Vehicle Storage
{ WARNING:
Batteries have acid that can burn you and gas that can explode. You can be badly hurt if you are not careful. See Jump Starting on page 6???44 for tips on working around a battery without
getting hurt.
Infrequent Usage: Remove the black, negative (???) cable from the battery to keep the battery from running down.
Extended Storage: Remove the black, negative (???) cable from the battery or use a battery trickle charger.
See
Jump Starting
For more information about the vehicle battery, see
Battery on page 6???42.
If the vehicle's battery has run down, you may want to use another vehicle and some jumper cables to start your vehicle. Be sure to use the following steps to do it safely.
{ WARNING:
Batteries can hurt you. They can be dangerous because:
.They contain acid that can burn you.
.They contain gas that can explode or ignite.
.They contain enough electricity to burn you.
If you do not follow these steps exactly, some or all of these things can hurt you.
Notice: Ignoring these steps could result in costly damage to the vehicle that would not be covered by the warranty.
Trying to start the vehicle by pushing or pulling it will not work, and it could damage the vehicle.
1.Check the other vehicle. It must have a
Notice: If the other vehicle's system is not a
2.Get the vehicles close enough so the jumper cables can reach, but be sure the vehicles are not touching each other. If they are, it could cause a ground connection you do not want. You would not be able to start your vehicle, and the bad grounding could damage the electrical systems.
To avoid the possibility of the vehicles rolling, set the parking brake firmly on both vehicles involved in the jump start procedure. Put an automatic transmission in P (Park) or a manual transmission in Neutral before setting the parking brake.
Notice: If you leave the radio or other accessories on during the jump starting procedure, they could be damaged. The repairs would not be covered by the warranty. Always turn off the radio and other accessories when jump starting the vehicle.
3.Turn off the ignition on both vehicles. Unplug unnecessary accessories plugged into the cigarette lighter or the accessory power outlet(s). Turn off the radio and all lamps that are not needed. This will avoid sparks and help save both batteries. And it could save the radio!
4.Open the hood on the other vehicle and locate the positive (+) and negative (???) terminal locations on that vehicle.
You will not see the battery of your vehicle under the hood. It is located under the rear passenger's seat. You will not need to access the battery for jump starting. The remote positive (+) terminal is for that purpose. See Engine Compartment Overview on page 6???14 for location.
Access the remote positive (+) terminal by removing the cover.
{ WARNING:
An electric fan can start up even when the engine is not running and can injure you. Keep hands, clothing and tools away from any underhood electric fan.
{ WARNING:
Using an open flame near a battery can cause battery gas to explode. People have been hurt doing this, and some have been blinded. Use a flashlight if you need more light.
Be sure the battery has enough water. You do not need to add water to the battery installed in your new vehicle. But if a battery has filler caps, be sure the right amount of fluid is there. If it is low, add water to take care of that first. If you do not, explosive gas could be present.
Battery fluid contains acid that can burn you. Do not get it on you. If you accidentally get it in your eyes or on your skin, flush the place with water and get medical help immediately.
{ WARNING:
Fans or other moving engine parts can injure you badly. Keep your hands away from moving parts once the engine is running.
5.Check that the jumper cables do not have loose or missing insulation. If they do, you could get a shock. The vehicles could be damaged too.
Before you connect the cables, here are some basic things you should know. Positive (+) will go to positive (+) or to a remote positive (+) terminal if the vehicle has one. Negative (???) will go to a heavy, unpainted metal engine part or to a remote negative (???) terminal if the vehicle has one.
Do not connect positive (+) to negative (???) or you will get a short that would damage the battery and maybe other parts too. And do not connect the negative (???) cable to the negative (???) terminal on the dead battery because this can cause sparks.
6.Connect the red positive (+) cable to the positive (+) terminal of the dead battery. Use a remote positive (+) terminal if the vehicle has one.
7.Do not let the other end touch metal. Connect it to the positive (+) terminal of the good battery. Use a remote positive (+) terminal if the vehicle has one.
8.Now connect the black negative (???) cable to the negative (???) terminal of the good battery. Use a remote negative (???) terminal if the vehicle has one.
Do not let the other end touch anything until the next step. The other end of the negative (???) cable does not go to the dead battery. It goes to a heavy, unpainted metal engine part or to a remote negative (???) terminal on the vehicle with the dead battery.
9.Connect the other end of the negative (???) cable at least 18 inches (45 cm) away from the dead battery, but not near engine parts that move. The electrical connection is just as good there, and the chance of sparks getting back to the battery is much less.
10.Now start the vehicle with the good battery and run the engine for a while.
11.Try to start the vehicle that had the dead battery. If it will not start after a few tries, it probably needs service.
Notice: If the jumper cables are connected or removed in the wrong order, electrical shorting may occur and damage the vehicle. The repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Always connect and remove the jumper cables in the correct order, making sure that the cables do not touch each other or other metal.
Jumper Cable Removal
A.Dead Battery or Remote Positive (+) Terminal
B.Good Battery or Remote Positive (+) and Remote Negative (???) Terminals
C.Heavy, Unpainted Metal Engine Part or Remote Negative (???) Terminal
To disconnect the jumper cables from both vehicles, do the following:
1.Disconnect the black negative (???) cable from the vehicle that had the dead battery.
2.Disconnect the black negative (???) cable from the vehicle with the good battery.